]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blob - bfd/elf.c
Support ELF SHF_GNU_MBIND and PT_GNU_MBIND_XXX
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / bfd / elf.c
1 /* ELF executable support for BFD.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1993-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
19 Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston,
20 MA 02110-1301, USA. */
21
22
23 /*
24 SECTION
25 ELF backends
26
27 BFD support for ELF formats is being worked on.
28 Currently, the best supported back ends are for sparc and i386
29 (running svr4 or Solaris 2).
30
31 Documentation of the internals of the support code still needs
32 to be written. The code is changing quickly enough that we
33 haven't bothered yet. */
34
35 /* For sparc64-cross-sparc32. */
36 #define _SYSCALL32
37 #include "sysdep.h"
38 #include "bfd.h"
39 #include "bfdlink.h"
40 #include "libbfd.h"
41 #define ARCH_SIZE 0
42 #include "elf-bfd.h"
43 #include "libiberty.h"
44 #include "safe-ctype.h"
45 #include "elf-linux-core.h"
46
47 #ifdef CORE_HEADER
48 #include CORE_HEADER
49 #endif
50
51 static int elf_sort_sections (const void *, const void *);
52 static bfd_boolean assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *);
53 static bfd_boolean prep_headers (bfd *);
54 static bfd_boolean swap_out_syms (bfd *, struct elf_strtab_hash **, int) ;
55 static bfd_boolean elf_read_notes (bfd *, file_ptr, bfd_size_type) ;
56 static bfd_boolean elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size,
57 file_ptr offset);
58
59 /* Swap version information in and out. The version information is
60 currently size independent. If that ever changes, this code will
61 need to move into elfcode.h. */
62
63 /* Swap in a Verdef structure. */
64
65 void
66 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (bfd *abfd,
67 const Elf_External_Verdef *src,
68 Elf_Internal_Verdef *dst)
69 {
70 dst->vd_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_version);
71 dst->vd_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags);
72 dst->vd_ndx = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx);
73 dst->vd_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt);
74 dst->vd_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash);
75 dst->vd_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux);
76 dst->vd_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_next);
77 }
78
79 /* Swap out a Verdef structure. */
80
81 void
82 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_out (bfd *abfd,
83 const Elf_Internal_Verdef *src,
84 Elf_External_Verdef *dst)
85 {
86 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_version, dst->vd_version);
87 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags, dst->vd_flags);
88 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx, dst->vd_ndx);
89 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt, dst->vd_cnt);
90 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash, dst->vd_hash);
91 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux, dst->vd_aux);
92 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_next, dst->vd_next);
93 }
94
95 /* Swap in a Verdaux structure. */
96
97 void
98 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (bfd *abfd,
99 const Elf_External_Verdaux *src,
100 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *dst)
101 {
102 dst->vda_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_name);
103 dst->vda_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_next);
104 }
105
106 /* Swap out a Verdaux structure. */
107
108 void
109 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_out (bfd *abfd,
110 const Elf_Internal_Verdaux *src,
111 Elf_External_Verdaux *dst)
112 {
113 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_name, dst->vda_name);
114 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_next, dst->vda_next);
115 }
116
117 /* Swap in a Verneed structure. */
118
119 void
120 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (bfd *abfd,
121 const Elf_External_Verneed *src,
122 Elf_Internal_Verneed *dst)
123 {
124 dst->vn_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_version);
125 dst->vn_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt);
126 dst->vn_file = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_file);
127 dst->vn_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux);
128 dst->vn_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_next);
129 }
130
131 /* Swap out a Verneed structure. */
132
133 void
134 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_out (bfd *abfd,
135 const Elf_Internal_Verneed *src,
136 Elf_External_Verneed *dst)
137 {
138 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_version, dst->vn_version);
139 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt, dst->vn_cnt);
140 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_file, dst->vn_file);
141 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux, dst->vn_aux);
142 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_next, dst->vn_next);
143 }
144
145 /* Swap in a Vernaux structure. */
146
147 void
148 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (bfd *abfd,
149 const Elf_External_Vernaux *src,
150 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *dst)
151 {
152 dst->vna_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash);
153 dst->vna_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags);
154 dst->vna_other = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_other);
155 dst->vna_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_name);
156 dst->vna_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_next);
157 }
158
159 /* Swap out a Vernaux structure. */
160
161 void
162 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_out (bfd *abfd,
163 const Elf_Internal_Vernaux *src,
164 Elf_External_Vernaux *dst)
165 {
166 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash, dst->vna_hash);
167 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags, dst->vna_flags);
168 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_other, dst->vna_other);
169 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_name, dst->vna_name);
170 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_next, dst->vna_next);
171 }
172
173 /* Swap in a Versym structure. */
174
175 void
176 _bfd_elf_swap_versym_in (bfd *abfd,
177 const Elf_External_Versym *src,
178 Elf_Internal_Versym *dst)
179 {
180 dst->vs_vers = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers);
181 }
182
183 /* Swap out a Versym structure. */
184
185 void
186 _bfd_elf_swap_versym_out (bfd *abfd,
187 const Elf_Internal_Versym *src,
188 Elf_External_Versym *dst)
189 {
190 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers, dst->vs_vers);
191 }
192
193 /* Standard ELF hash function. Do not change this function; you will
194 cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
195
196 unsigned long
197 bfd_elf_hash (const char *namearg)
198 {
199 const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
200 unsigned long h = 0;
201 unsigned long g;
202 int ch;
203
204 while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
205 {
206 h = (h << 4) + ch;
207 if ((g = (h & 0xf0000000)) != 0)
208 {
209 h ^= g >> 24;
210 /* The ELF ABI says `h &= ~g', but this is equivalent in
211 this case and on some machines one insn instead of two. */
212 h ^= g;
213 }
214 }
215 return h & 0xffffffff;
216 }
217
218 /* DT_GNU_HASH hash function. Do not change this function; you will
219 cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
220
221 unsigned long
222 bfd_elf_gnu_hash (const char *namearg)
223 {
224 const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
225 unsigned long h = 5381;
226 unsigned char ch;
227
228 while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
229 h = (h << 5) + h + ch;
230 return h & 0xffffffff;
231 }
232
233 /* Create a tdata field OBJECT_SIZE bytes in length, zeroed out and with
234 the object_id field of an elf_obj_tdata field set to OBJECT_ID. */
235 bfd_boolean
236 bfd_elf_allocate_object (bfd *abfd,
237 size_t object_size,
238 enum elf_target_id object_id)
239 {
240 BFD_ASSERT (object_size >= sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata));
241 abfd->tdata.any = bfd_zalloc (abfd, object_size);
242 if (abfd->tdata.any == NULL)
243 return FALSE;
244
245 elf_object_id (abfd) = object_id;
246 if (abfd->direction != read_direction)
247 {
248 struct output_elf_obj_tdata *o = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof *o);
249 if (o == NULL)
250 return FALSE;
251 elf_tdata (abfd)->o = o;
252 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = (bfd_size_type) -1;
253 }
254 return TRUE;
255 }
256
257
258 bfd_boolean
259 bfd_elf_make_object (bfd *abfd)
260 {
261 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
262 return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata),
263 bed->target_id);
264 }
265
266 bfd_boolean
267 bfd_elf_mkcorefile (bfd *abfd)
268 {
269 /* I think this can be done just like an object file. */
270 if (!abfd->xvec->_bfd_set_format[(int) bfd_object] (abfd))
271 return FALSE;
272 elf_tdata (abfd)->core = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*elf_tdata (abfd)->core));
273 return elf_tdata (abfd)->core != NULL;
274 }
275
276 static char *
277 bfd_elf_get_str_section (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
278 {
279 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
280 bfd_byte *shstrtab = NULL;
281 file_ptr offset;
282 bfd_size_type shstrtabsize;
283
284 i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
285 if (i_shdrp == 0
286 || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd)
287 || i_shdrp[shindex] == 0)
288 return NULL;
289
290 shstrtab = i_shdrp[shindex]->contents;
291 if (shstrtab == NULL)
292 {
293 /* No cached one, attempt to read, and cache what we read. */
294 offset = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_offset;
295 shstrtabsize = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size;
296
297 /* Allocate and clear an extra byte at the end, to prevent crashes
298 in case the string table is not terminated. */
299 if (shstrtabsize + 1 <= 1
300 || bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
301 || (shstrtab = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc (abfd, shstrtabsize + 1)) == NULL)
302 shstrtab = NULL;
303 else if (bfd_bread (shstrtab, shstrtabsize, abfd) != shstrtabsize)
304 {
305 if (bfd_get_error () != bfd_error_system_call)
306 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_truncated);
307 bfd_release (abfd, shstrtab);
308 shstrtab = NULL;
309 /* Once we've failed to read it, make sure we don't keep
310 trying. Otherwise, we'll keep allocating space for
311 the string table over and over. */
312 i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size = 0;
313 }
314 else
315 shstrtab[shstrtabsize] = '\0';
316 i_shdrp[shindex]->contents = shstrtab;
317 }
318 return (char *) shstrtab;
319 }
320
321 char *
322 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (bfd *abfd,
323 unsigned int shindex,
324 unsigned int strindex)
325 {
326 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
327
328 if (strindex == 0)
329 return "";
330
331 if (elf_elfsections (abfd) == NULL || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
332 return NULL;
333
334 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
335
336 if (hdr->contents == NULL)
337 {
338 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB && hdr->sh_type < SHT_LOOS)
339 {
340 /* PR 17512: file: f057ec89. */
341 /* xgettext:c-format */
342 _bfd_error_handler (_("%B: attempt to load strings from a non-string section (number %d)"),
343 abfd, shindex);
344 return NULL;
345 }
346
347 if (bfd_elf_get_str_section (abfd, shindex) == NULL)
348 return NULL;
349 }
350
351 if (strindex >= hdr->sh_size)
352 {
353 unsigned int shstrndx = elf_elfheader(abfd)->e_shstrndx;
354 _bfd_error_handler
355 /* xgettext:c-format */
356 (_("%B: invalid string offset %u >= %lu for section `%s'"),
357 abfd, strindex, (unsigned long) hdr->sh_size,
358 (shindex == shstrndx && strindex == hdr->sh_name
359 ? ".shstrtab"
360 : bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shstrndx, hdr->sh_name)));
361 return NULL;
362 }
363
364 return ((char *) hdr->contents) + strindex;
365 }
366
367 /* Read and convert symbols to internal format.
368 SYMCOUNT specifies the number of symbols to read, starting from
369 symbol SYMOFFSET. If any of INTSYM_BUF, EXTSYM_BUF or EXTSHNDX_BUF
370 are non-NULL, they are used to store the internal symbols, external
371 symbols, and symbol section index extensions, respectively.
372 Returns a pointer to the internal symbol buffer (malloced if necessary)
373 or NULL if there were no symbols or some kind of problem. */
374
375 Elf_Internal_Sym *
376 bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (bfd *ibfd,
377 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
378 size_t symcount,
379 size_t symoffset,
380 Elf_Internal_Sym *intsym_buf,
381 void *extsym_buf,
382 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *extshndx_buf)
383 {
384 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shndx_hdr;
385 void *alloc_ext;
386 const bfd_byte *esym;
387 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *alloc_extshndx;
388 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *shndx;
389 Elf_Internal_Sym *alloc_intsym;
390 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
391 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymend;
392 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
393 size_t extsym_size;
394 bfd_size_type amt;
395 file_ptr pos;
396
397 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
398 abort ();
399
400 if (symcount == 0)
401 return intsym_buf;
402
403 /* Normal syms might have section extension entries. */
404 shndx_hdr = NULL;
405 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd) != NULL)
406 {
407 elf_section_list * entry;
408 Elf_Internal_Shdr **sections = elf_elfsections (ibfd);
409
410 /* Find an index section that is linked to this symtab section. */
411 for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
412 {
413 /* PR 20063. */
414 if (entry->hdr.sh_link >= elf_numsections (ibfd))
415 continue;
416
417 if (sections[entry->hdr.sh_link] == symtab_hdr)
418 {
419 shndx_hdr = & entry->hdr;
420 break;
421 };
422 }
423
424 if (shndx_hdr == NULL)
425 {
426 if (symtab_hdr == & elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd))
427 /* Not really accurate, but this was how the old code used to work. */
428 shndx_hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd)->hdr;
429 /* Otherwise we do nothing. The assumption is that
430 the index table will not be needed. */
431 }
432 }
433
434 /* Read the symbols. */
435 alloc_ext = NULL;
436 alloc_extshndx = NULL;
437 alloc_intsym = NULL;
438 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
439 extsym_size = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
440 amt = (bfd_size_type) symcount * extsym_size;
441 pos = symtab_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * extsym_size;
442 if (extsym_buf == NULL)
443 {
444 alloc_ext = bfd_malloc2 (symcount, extsym_size);
445 extsym_buf = alloc_ext;
446 }
447 if (extsym_buf == NULL
448 || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
449 || bfd_bread (extsym_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
450 {
451 intsym_buf = NULL;
452 goto out;
453 }
454
455 if (shndx_hdr == NULL || shndx_hdr->sh_size == 0)
456 extshndx_buf = NULL;
457 else
458 {
459 amt = (bfd_size_type) symcount * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
460 pos = shndx_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
461 if (extshndx_buf == NULL)
462 {
463 alloc_extshndx = (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *)
464 bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
465 extshndx_buf = alloc_extshndx;
466 }
467 if (extshndx_buf == NULL
468 || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
469 || bfd_bread (extshndx_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
470 {
471 intsym_buf = NULL;
472 goto out;
473 }
474 }
475
476 if (intsym_buf == NULL)
477 {
478 alloc_intsym = (Elf_Internal_Sym *)
479 bfd_malloc2 (symcount, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Sym));
480 intsym_buf = alloc_intsym;
481 if (intsym_buf == NULL)
482 goto out;
483 }
484
485 /* Convert the symbols to internal form. */
486 isymend = intsym_buf + symcount;
487 for (esym = (const bfd_byte *) extsym_buf, isym = intsym_buf,
488 shndx = extshndx_buf;
489 isym < isymend;
490 esym += extsym_size, isym++, shndx = shndx != NULL ? shndx + 1 : NULL)
491 if (!(*bed->s->swap_symbol_in) (ibfd, esym, shndx, isym))
492 {
493 symoffset += (esym - (bfd_byte *) extsym_buf) / extsym_size;
494 /* xgettext:c-format */
495 _bfd_error_handler (_("%B symbol number %lu references "
496 "nonexistent SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX section"),
497 ibfd, (unsigned long) symoffset);
498 if (alloc_intsym != NULL)
499 free (alloc_intsym);
500 intsym_buf = NULL;
501 goto out;
502 }
503
504 out:
505 if (alloc_ext != NULL)
506 free (alloc_ext);
507 if (alloc_extshndx != NULL)
508 free (alloc_extshndx);
509
510 return intsym_buf;
511 }
512
513 /* Look up a symbol name. */
514 const char *
515 bfd_elf_sym_name (bfd *abfd,
516 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
517 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
518 asection *sym_sec)
519 {
520 const char *name;
521 unsigned int iname = isym->st_name;
522 unsigned int shindex = symtab_hdr->sh_link;
523
524 if (iname == 0 && ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
525 /* Check for a bogus st_shndx to avoid crashing. */
526 && isym->st_shndx < elf_numsections (abfd))
527 {
528 iname = elf_elfsections (abfd)[isym->st_shndx]->sh_name;
529 shindex = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx;
530 }
531
532 name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shindex, iname);
533 if (name == NULL)
534 name = "(null)";
535 else if (sym_sec && *name == '\0')
536 name = bfd_section_name (abfd, sym_sec);
537
538 return name;
539 }
540
541 /* Elf_Internal_Shdr->contents is an array of these for SHT_GROUP
542 sections. The first element is the flags, the rest are section
543 pointers. */
544
545 typedef union elf_internal_group {
546 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr;
547 unsigned int flags;
548 } Elf_Internal_Group;
549
550 /* Return the name of the group signature symbol. Why isn't the
551 signature just a string? */
552
553 static const char *
554 group_signature (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *ghdr)
555 {
556 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
557 unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
558 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
559 Elf_Internal_Sym isym;
560
561 /* First we need to ensure the symbol table is available. Make sure
562 that it is a symbol table section. */
563 if (ghdr->sh_link >= elf_numsections (abfd))
564 return NULL;
565 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd) [ghdr->sh_link];
566 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
567 || ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, ghdr->sh_link))
568 return NULL;
569
570 /* Go read the symbol. */
571 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
572 if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, hdr, 1, ghdr->sh_info,
573 &isym, esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
574 return NULL;
575
576 return bfd_elf_sym_name (abfd, hdr, &isym, NULL);
577 }
578
579 /* Set next_in_group list pointer, and group name for NEWSECT. */
580
581 static bfd_boolean
582 setup_group (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *newsect)
583 {
584 unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
585
586 /* If num_group is zero, read in all SHT_GROUP sections. The count
587 is set to -1 if there are no SHT_GROUP sections. */
588 if (num_group == 0)
589 {
590 unsigned int i, shnum;
591
592 /* First count the number of groups. If we have a SHT_GROUP
593 section with just a flag word (ie. sh_size is 4), ignore it. */
594 shnum = elf_numsections (abfd);
595 num_group = 0;
596
597 #define IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER(shdr, minsize) \
598 ( (shdr)->sh_type == SHT_GROUP \
599 && (shdr)->sh_size >= minsize \
600 && (shdr)->sh_entsize == GRP_ENTRY_SIZE \
601 && ((shdr)->sh_size % GRP_ENTRY_SIZE) == 0)
602
603 for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
604 {
605 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
606
607 if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
608 num_group += 1;
609 }
610
611 if (num_group == 0)
612 {
613 num_group = (unsigned) -1;
614 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
615 }
616 else
617 {
618 /* We keep a list of elf section headers for group sections,
619 so we can find them quickly. */
620 bfd_size_type amt;
621
622 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
623 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **)
624 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_group, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
625 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr == NULL)
626 return FALSE;
627
628 num_group = 0;
629 for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
630 {
631 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
632
633 if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
634 {
635 unsigned char *src;
636 Elf_Internal_Group *dest;
637
638 /* Add to list of sections. */
639 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[num_group] = shdr;
640 num_group += 1;
641
642 /* Read the raw contents. */
643 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (*dest) >= 4);
644 amt = shdr->sh_size * sizeof (*dest) / 4;
645 shdr->contents = (unsigned char *)
646 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, shdr->sh_size, sizeof (*dest) / 4);
647 /* PR binutils/4110: Handle corrupt group headers. */
648 if (shdr->contents == NULL)
649 {
650 _bfd_error_handler
651 /* xgettext:c-format */
652 (_("%B: corrupt size field in group section header: 0x%lx"), abfd, shdr->sh_size);
653 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
654 -- num_group;
655 continue;
656 }
657
658 memset (shdr->contents, 0, amt);
659
660 if (bfd_seek (abfd, shdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
661 || (bfd_bread (shdr->contents, shdr->sh_size, abfd)
662 != shdr->sh_size))
663 {
664 _bfd_error_handler
665 /* xgettext:c-format */
666 (_("%B: invalid size field in group section header: 0x%lx"), abfd, shdr->sh_size);
667 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
668 -- num_group;
669 /* PR 17510: If the group contents are even partially
670 corrupt, do not allow any of the contents to be used. */
671 memset (shdr->contents, 0, amt);
672 continue;
673 }
674
675 /* Translate raw contents, a flag word followed by an
676 array of elf section indices all in target byte order,
677 to the flag word followed by an array of elf section
678 pointers. */
679 src = shdr->contents + shdr->sh_size;
680 dest = (Elf_Internal_Group *) (shdr->contents + amt);
681
682 while (1)
683 {
684 unsigned int idx;
685
686 src -= 4;
687 --dest;
688 idx = H_GET_32 (abfd, src);
689 if (src == shdr->contents)
690 {
691 dest->flags = idx;
692 if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL && (idx & GRP_COMDAT))
693 shdr->bfd_section->flags
694 |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
695 break;
696 }
697 if (idx >= shnum)
698 {
699 _bfd_error_handler
700 (_("%B: invalid SHT_GROUP entry"), abfd);
701 idx = 0;
702 }
703 dest->shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[idx];
704 }
705 }
706 }
707
708 /* PR 17510: Corrupt binaries might contain invalid groups. */
709 if (num_group != (unsigned) elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group)
710 {
711 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
712
713 /* If all groups are invalid then fail. */
714 if (num_group == 0)
715 {
716 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = NULL;
717 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group = -1;
718 _bfd_error_handler
719 (_("%B: no valid group sections found"), abfd);
720 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
721 }
722 }
723 }
724 }
725
726 if (num_group != (unsigned) -1)
727 {
728 unsigned int i;
729
730 for (i = 0; i < num_group; i++)
731 {
732 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
733 Elf_Internal_Group *idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
734 unsigned int n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
735
736 /* Look through this group's sections to see if current
737 section is a member. */
738 while (--n_elt != 0)
739 if ((++idx)->shdr == hdr)
740 {
741 asection *s = NULL;
742
743 /* We are a member of this group. Go looking through
744 other members to see if any others are linked via
745 next_in_group. */
746 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
747 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
748 while (--n_elt != 0)
749 if ((s = (++idx)->shdr->bfd_section) != NULL
750 && elf_next_in_group (s) != NULL)
751 break;
752 if (n_elt != 0)
753 {
754 /* Snarf the group name from other member, and
755 insert current section in circular list. */
756 elf_group_name (newsect) = elf_group_name (s);
757 elf_next_in_group (newsect) = elf_next_in_group (s);
758 elf_next_in_group (s) = newsect;
759 }
760 else
761 {
762 const char *gname;
763
764 gname = group_signature (abfd, shdr);
765 if (gname == NULL)
766 return FALSE;
767 elf_group_name (newsect) = gname;
768
769 /* Start a circular list with one element. */
770 elf_next_in_group (newsect) = newsect;
771 }
772
773 /* If the group section has been created, point to the
774 new member. */
775 if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL)
776 elf_next_in_group (shdr->bfd_section) = newsect;
777
778 i = num_group - 1;
779 break;
780 }
781 }
782 }
783
784 if (elf_group_name (newsect) == NULL)
785 {
786 /* xgettext:c-format */
787 _bfd_error_handler (_("%B: no group info for section %A"),
788 abfd, newsect);
789 return FALSE;
790 }
791 return TRUE;
792 }
793
794 bfd_boolean
795 _bfd_elf_setup_sections (bfd *abfd)
796 {
797 unsigned int i;
798 unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
799 bfd_boolean result = TRUE;
800 asection *s;
801
802 /* Process SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
803 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
804 {
805 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr = &elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr;
806 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
807 {
808 unsigned int elfsec = this_hdr->sh_link;
809 /* FIXME: The old Intel compiler and old strip/objcopy may
810 not set the sh_link or sh_info fields. Hence we could
811 get the situation where elfsec is 0. */
812 if (elfsec == 0)
813 {
814 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
815 if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
816 bed->link_order_error_handler
817 /* xgettext:c-format */
818 (_("%B: warning: sh_link not set for section `%A'"),
819 abfd, s);
820 }
821 else
822 {
823 asection *linksec = NULL;
824
825 if (elfsec < elf_numsections (abfd))
826 {
827 this_hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec];
828 linksec = this_hdr->bfd_section;
829 }
830
831 /* PR 1991, 2008:
832 Some strip/objcopy may leave an incorrect value in
833 sh_link. We don't want to proceed. */
834 if (linksec == NULL)
835 {
836 _bfd_error_handler
837 /* xgettext:c-format */
838 (_("%B: sh_link [%d] in section `%A' is incorrect"),
839 s->owner, s, elfsec);
840 result = FALSE;
841 }
842
843 elf_linked_to_section (s) = linksec;
844 }
845 }
846 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP
847 && elf_next_in_group (s) == NULL)
848 {
849 _bfd_error_handler
850 /* xgettext:c-format */
851 (_("%B: SHT_GROUP section [index %d] has no SHF_GROUP sections"),
852 abfd, elf_section_data (s)->this_idx);
853 result = FALSE;
854 }
855 }
856
857 /* Process section groups. */
858 if (num_group == (unsigned) -1)
859 return result;
860
861 for (i = 0; i < num_group; i++)
862 {
863 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
864 Elf_Internal_Group *idx;
865 unsigned int n_elt;
866
867 /* PR binutils/18758: Beware of corrupt binaries with invalid group data. */
868 if (shdr == NULL || shdr->bfd_section == NULL || shdr->contents == NULL)
869 {
870 _bfd_error_handler
871 /* xgettext:c-format */
872 (_("%B: section group entry number %u is corrupt"),
873 abfd, i);
874 result = FALSE;
875 continue;
876 }
877
878 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
879 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
880
881 while (--n_elt != 0)
882 if ((++idx)->shdr->bfd_section)
883 elf_sec_group (idx->shdr->bfd_section) = shdr->bfd_section;
884 else if (idx->shdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA
885 || idx->shdr->sh_type == SHT_REL)
886 /* We won't include relocation sections in section groups in
887 output object files. We adjust the group section size here
888 so that relocatable link will work correctly when
889 relocation sections are in section group in input object
890 files. */
891 shdr->bfd_section->size -= 4;
892 else
893 {
894 /* There are some unknown sections in the group. */
895 _bfd_error_handler
896 /* xgettext:c-format */
897 (_("%B: unknown [%d] section `%s' in group [%s]"),
898 abfd,
899 (unsigned int) idx->shdr->sh_type,
900 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd,
901 (elf_elfheader (abfd)
902 ->e_shstrndx),
903 idx->shdr->sh_name),
904 shdr->bfd_section->name);
905 result = FALSE;
906 }
907 }
908 return result;
909 }
910
911 bfd_boolean
912 bfd_elf_is_group_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, const asection *sec)
913 {
914 return elf_next_in_group (sec) != NULL;
915 }
916
917 static char *
918 convert_debug_to_zdebug (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
919 {
920 unsigned int len = strlen (name);
921 char *new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 2);
922 if (new_name == NULL)
923 return NULL;
924 new_name[0] = '.';
925 new_name[1] = 'z';
926 memcpy (new_name + 2, name + 1, len);
927 return new_name;
928 }
929
930 static char *
931 convert_zdebug_to_debug (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
932 {
933 unsigned int len = strlen (name);
934 char *new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
935 if (new_name == NULL)
936 return NULL;
937 new_name[0] = '.';
938 memcpy (new_name + 1, name + 2, len - 1);
939 return new_name;
940 }
941
942 /* Make a BFD section from an ELF section. We store a pointer to the
943 BFD section in the bfd_section field of the header. */
944
945 bfd_boolean
946 _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
947 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
948 const char *name,
949 int shindex)
950 {
951 asection *newsect;
952 flagword flags;
953 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
954
955 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
956 return TRUE;
957
958 newsect = bfd_make_section_anyway (abfd, name);
959 if (newsect == NULL)
960 return FALSE;
961
962 hdr->bfd_section = newsect;
963 elf_section_data (newsect)->this_hdr = *hdr;
964 elf_section_data (newsect)->this_idx = shindex;
965
966 /* Always use the real type/flags. */
967 elf_section_type (newsect) = hdr->sh_type;
968 elf_section_flags (newsect) = hdr->sh_flags;
969
970 newsect->filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
971
972 if (! bfd_set_section_vma (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_addr)
973 || ! bfd_set_section_size (abfd, newsect, hdr->sh_size)
974 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, newsect,
975 bfd_log2 (hdr->sh_addralign)))
976 return FALSE;
977
978 flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
979 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
980 flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
981 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
982 flags |= SEC_GROUP | SEC_EXCLUDE;
983 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
984 {
985 flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
986 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
987 flags |= SEC_LOAD;
988 }
989 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) == 0)
990 flags |= SEC_READONLY;
991 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
992 flags |= SEC_CODE;
993 else if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
994 flags |= SEC_DATA;
995 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_MERGE) != 0)
996 {
997 flags |= SEC_MERGE;
998 newsect->entsize = hdr->sh_entsize;
999 }
1000 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_STRINGS) != 0)
1001 flags |= SEC_STRINGS;
1002 if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP)
1003 if (!setup_group (abfd, hdr, newsect))
1004 return FALSE;
1005 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0)
1006 flags |= SEC_THREAD_LOCAL;
1007 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE) != 0)
1008 flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1009
1010 if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
1011 {
1012 /* The debugging sections appear to be recognized only by name,
1013 not any sort of flag. Their SEC_ALLOC bits are cleared. */
1014 if (name [0] == '.')
1015 {
1016 const char *p;
1017 int n;
1018 if (name[1] == 'd')
1019 p = ".debug", n = 6;
1020 else if (name[1] == 'g' && name[2] == 'n')
1021 p = ".gnu.linkonce.wi.", n = 17;
1022 else if (name[1] == 'g' && name[2] == 'd')
1023 p = ".gdb_index", n = 11; /* yes we really do mean 11. */
1024 else if (name[1] == 'l')
1025 p = ".line", n = 5;
1026 else if (name[1] == 's')
1027 p = ".stab", n = 5;
1028 else if (name[1] == 'z')
1029 p = ".zdebug", n = 7;
1030 else
1031 p = NULL, n = 0;
1032 if (p != NULL && strncmp (name, p, n) == 0)
1033 flags |= SEC_DEBUGGING;
1034 }
1035 }
1036
1037 /* As a GNU extension, if the name begins with .gnu.linkonce, we
1038 only link a single copy of the section. This is used to support
1039 g++. g++ will emit each template expansion in its own section.
1040 The symbols will be defined as weak, so that multiple definitions
1041 are permitted. The GNU linker extension is to actually discard
1042 all but one of the sections. */
1043 if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gnu.linkonce")
1044 && elf_next_in_group (newsect) == NULL)
1045 flags |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
1046
1047 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1048 if (bed->elf_backend_section_flags)
1049 if (! bed->elf_backend_section_flags (&flags, hdr))
1050 return FALSE;
1051
1052 if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, newsect, flags))
1053 return FALSE;
1054
1055 /* We do not parse the PT_NOTE segments as we are interested even in the
1056 separate debug info files which may have the segments offsets corrupted.
1057 PT_NOTEs from the core files are currently not parsed using BFD. */
1058 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOTE)
1059 {
1060 bfd_byte *contents;
1061
1062 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, newsect, &contents))
1063 return FALSE;
1064
1065 elf_parse_notes (abfd, (char *) contents, hdr->sh_size, hdr->sh_offset);
1066 free (contents);
1067 }
1068
1069 if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1070 {
1071 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdr;
1072 unsigned int i, nload;
1073
1074 /* Some ELF linkers produce binaries with all the program header
1075 p_paddr fields zero. If we have such a binary with more than
1076 one PT_LOAD header, then leave the section lma equal to vma
1077 so that we don't create sections with overlapping lma. */
1078 phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1079 for (nload = 0, i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
1080 if (phdr->p_paddr != 0)
1081 break;
1082 else if (phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD && phdr->p_memsz != 0)
1083 ++nload;
1084 if (i >= elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum && nload > 1)
1085 return TRUE;
1086
1087 phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1088 for (i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
1089 {
1090 if (((phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD
1091 && (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
1092 || phdr->p_type == PT_TLS)
1093 && ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (hdr, phdr))
1094 {
1095 if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
1096 newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
1097 + hdr->sh_addr - phdr->p_vaddr);
1098 else
1099 /* We used to use the same adjustment for SEC_LOAD
1100 sections, but that doesn't work if the segment
1101 is packed with code from multiple VMAs.
1102 Instead we calculate the section LMA based on
1103 the segment LMA. It is assumed that the
1104 segment will contain sections with contiguous
1105 LMAs, even if the VMAs are not. */
1106 newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
1107 + hdr->sh_offset - phdr->p_offset);
1108
1109 /* With contiguous segments, we can't tell from file
1110 offsets whether a section with zero size should
1111 be placed at the end of one segment or the
1112 beginning of the next. Decide based on vaddr. */
1113 if (hdr->sh_addr >= phdr->p_vaddr
1114 && (hdr->sh_addr + hdr->sh_size
1115 <= phdr->p_vaddr + phdr->p_memsz))
1116 break;
1117 }
1118 }
1119 }
1120
1121 /* Compress/decompress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_* and
1122 .zdebug_*, after the section flags is set. */
1123 if ((flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
1124 && ((name[1] == 'd' && name[6] == '_')
1125 || (name[1] == 'z' && name[7] == '_')))
1126 {
1127 enum { nothing, compress, decompress } action = nothing;
1128 int compression_header_size;
1129 bfd_size_type uncompressed_size;
1130 bfd_boolean compressed
1131 = bfd_is_section_compressed_with_header (abfd, newsect,
1132 &compression_header_size,
1133 &uncompressed_size);
1134
1135 if (compressed)
1136 {
1137 /* Compressed section. Check if we should decompress. */
1138 if ((abfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS))
1139 action = decompress;
1140 }
1141
1142 /* Compress the uncompressed section or convert from/to .zdebug*
1143 section. Check if we should compress. */
1144 if (action == nothing)
1145 {
1146 if (newsect->size != 0
1147 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS)
1148 && compression_header_size >= 0
1149 && uncompressed_size > 0
1150 && (!compressed
1151 || ((compression_header_size > 0)
1152 != ((abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) != 0))))
1153 action = compress;
1154 else
1155 return TRUE;
1156 }
1157
1158 if (action == compress)
1159 {
1160 if (!bfd_init_section_compress_status (abfd, newsect))
1161 {
1162 _bfd_error_handler
1163 /* xgettext:c-format */
1164 (_("%B: unable to initialize compress status for section %s"),
1165 abfd, name);
1166 return FALSE;
1167 }
1168 }
1169 else
1170 {
1171 if (!bfd_init_section_decompress_status (abfd, newsect))
1172 {
1173 _bfd_error_handler
1174 /* xgettext:c-format */
1175 (_("%B: unable to initialize decompress status for section %s"),
1176 abfd, name);
1177 return FALSE;
1178 }
1179 }
1180
1181 if (abfd->is_linker_input)
1182 {
1183 if (name[1] == 'z'
1184 && (action == decompress
1185 || (action == compress
1186 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) != 0)))
1187 {
1188 /* Convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* so
1189 that linker will consider this section as a debug
1190 section. */
1191 char *new_name = convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd, name);
1192 if (new_name == NULL)
1193 return FALSE;
1194 bfd_rename_section (abfd, newsect, new_name);
1195 }
1196 }
1197 else
1198 /* For objdump, don't rename the section. For objcopy, delay
1199 section rename to elf_fake_sections. */
1200 newsect->flags |= SEC_ELF_RENAME;
1201 }
1202
1203 return TRUE;
1204 }
1205
1206 const char *const bfd_elf_section_type_names[] =
1207 {
1208 "SHT_NULL", "SHT_PROGBITS", "SHT_SYMTAB", "SHT_STRTAB",
1209 "SHT_RELA", "SHT_HASH", "SHT_DYNAMIC", "SHT_NOTE",
1210 "SHT_NOBITS", "SHT_REL", "SHT_SHLIB", "SHT_DYNSYM",
1211 };
1212
1213 /* ELF relocs are against symbols. If we are producing relocatable
1214 output, and the reloc is against an external symbol, and nothing
1215 has given us any additional addend, the resulting reloc will also
1216 be against the same symbol. In such a case, we don't want to
1217 change anything about the way the reloc is handled, since it will
1218 all be done at final link time. Rather than put special case code
1219 into bfd_perform_relocation, all the reloc types use this howto
1220 function. It just short circuits the reloc if producing
1221 relocatable output against an external symbol. */
1222
1223 bfd_reloc_status_type
1224 bfd_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1225 arelent *reloc_entry,
1226 asymbol *symbol,
1227 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1228 asection *input_section,
1229 bfd *output_bfd,
1230 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1231 {
1232 if (output_bfd != NULL
1233 && (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
1234 && (! reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace
1235 || reloc_entry->addend == 0))
1236 {
1237 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1238 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1239 }
1240
1241 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1242 }
1243 \f
1244 /* Returns TRUE if section A matches section B.
1245 Names, addresses and links may be different, but everything else
1246 should be the same. */
1247
1248 static bfd_boolean
1249 section_match (const Elf_Internal_Shdr * a,
1250 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * b)
1251 {
1252 return
1253 a->sh_type == b->sh_type
1254 && (a->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1255 == (b->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1256 && a->sh_addralign == b->sh_addralign
1257 && a->sh_size == b->sh_size
1258 && a->sh_entsize == b->sh_entsize
1259 /* FIXME: Check sh_addr ? */
1260 ;
1261 }
1262
1263 /* Find a section in OBFD that has the same characteristics
1264 as IHEADER. Return the index of this section or SHN_UNDEF if
1265 none can be found. Check's section HINT first, as this is likely
1266 to be the correct section. */
1267
1268 static unsigned int
1269 find_link (const bfd * obfd, const Elf_Internal_Shdr * iheader, const unsigned int hint)
1270 {
1271 Elf_Internal_Shdr ** oheaders = elf_elfsections (obfd);
1272 unsigned int i;
1273
1274 BFD_ASSERT (iheader != NULL);
1275
1276 /* See PR 20922 for a reproducer of the NULL test. */
1277 if (oheaders[hint] != NULL
1278 && section_match (oheaders[hint], iheader))
1279 return hint;
1280
1281 for (i = 1; i < elf_numsections (obfd); i++)
1282 {
1283 Elf_Internal_Shdr * oheader = oheaders[i];
1284
1285 if (oheader == NULL)
1286 continue;
1287 if (section_match (oheader, iheader))
1288 /* FIXME: Do we care if there is a potential for
1289 multiple matches ? */
1290 return i;
1291 }
1292
1293 return SHN_UNDEF;
1294 }
1295
1296 /* PR 19938: Attempt to set the ELF section header fields of an OS or
1297 Processor specific section, based upon a matching input section.
1298 Returns TRUE upon success, FALSE otherwise. */
1299
1300 static bfd_boolean
1301 copy_special_section_fields (const bfd *ibfd,
1302 bfd *obfd,
1303 const Elf_Internal_Shdr *iheader,
1304 Elf_Internal_Shdr *oheader,
1305 const unsigned int secnum)
1306 {
1307 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (obfd);
1308 const Elf_Internal_Shdr **iheaders = (const Elf_Internal_Shdr **) elf_elfsections (ibfd);
1309 bfd_boolean changed = FALSE;
1310 unsigned int sh_link;
1311
1312 if (oheader->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS)
1313 {
1314 /* This is a feature for objcopy --only-keep-debug:
1315 When a section's type is changed to NOBITS, we preserve
1316 the sh_link and sh_info fields so that they can be
1317 matched up with the original.
1318
1319 Note: Strictly speaking these assignments are wrong.
1320 The sh_link and sh_info fields should point to the
1321 relevent sections in the output BFD, which may not be in
1322 the same location as they were in the input BFD. But
1323 the whole point of this action is to preserve the
1324 original values of the sh_link and sh_info fields, so
1325 that they can be matched up with the section headers in
1326 the original file. So strictly speaking we may be
1327 creating an invalid ELF file, but it is only for a file
1328 that just contains debug info and only for sections
1329 without any contents. */
1330 if (oheader->sh_link == 0)
1331 oheader->sh_link = iheader->sh_link;
1332 if (oheader->sh_info == 0)
1333 oheader->sh_info = iheader->sh_info;
1334 return TRUE;
1335 }
1336
1337 /* Allow the target a chance to decide how these fields should be set. */
1338 if (bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields != NULL
1339 && bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields
1340 (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader))
1341 return TRUE;
1342
1343 /* We have an iheader which might match oheader, and which has non-zero
1344 sh_info and/or sh_link fields. Attempt to follow those links and find
1345 the section in the output bfd which corresponds to the linked section
1346 in the input bfd. */
1347 if (iheader->sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1348 {
1349 /* See PR 20931 for a reproducer. */
1350 if (iheader->sh_link >= elf_numsections (ibfd))
1351 {
1352 (* _bfd_error_handler)
1353 /* xgettext:c-format */
1354 (_("%B: Invalid sh_link field (%d) in section number %d"),
1355 ibfd, iheader->sh_link, secnum);
1356 return FALSE;
1357 }
1358
1359 sh_link = find_link (obfd, iheaders[iheader->sh_link], iheader->sh_link);
1360 if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1361 {
1362 oheader->sh_link = sh_link;
1363 changed = TRUE;
1364 }
1365 else
1366 /* FIXME: Should we install iheader->sh_link
1367 if we could not find a match ? */
1368 (* _bfd_error_handler)
1369 /* xgettext:c-format */
1370 (_("%B: Failed to find link section for section %d"), obfd, secnum);
1371 }
1372
1373 if (iheader->sh_info)
1374 {
1375 /* The sh_info field can hold arbitrary information, but if the
1376 SHF_LINK_INFO flag is set then it should be interpreted as a
1377 section index. */
1378 if (iheader->sh_flags & SHF_INFO_LINK)
1379 {
1380 sh_link = find_link (obfd, iheaders[iheader->sh_info],
1381 iheader->sh_info);
1382 if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1383 oheader->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
1384 }
1385 else
1386 /* No idea what it means - just copy it. */
1387 sh_link = iheader->sh_info;
1388
1389 if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1390 {
1391 oheader->sh_info = sh_link;
1392 changed = TRUE;
1393 }
1394 else
1395 (* _bfd_error_handler)
1396 /* xgettext:c-format */
1397 (_("%B: Failed to find info section for section %d"), obfd, secnum);
1398 }
1399
1400 return changed;
1401 }
1402
1403 /* Copy the program header and other data from one object module to
1404 another. */
1405
1406 bfd_boolean
1407 _bfd_elf_copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
1408 {
1409 const Elf_Internal_Shdr **iheaders = (const Elf_Internal_Shdr **) elf_elfsections (ibfd);
1410 Elf_Internal_Shdr **oheaders = elf_elfsections (obfd);
1411 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1412 unsigned int i;
1413
1414 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
1415 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
1416 return TRUE;
1417
1418 if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
1419 {
1420 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
1421 elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
1422 }
1423
1424 elf_gp (obfd) = elf_gp (ibfd);
1425
1426 /* Also copy the EI_OSABI field. */
1427 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI] =
1428 elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI];
1429
1430 /* If set, copy the EI_ABIVERSION field. */
1431 if (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION])
1432 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION]
1433 = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION];
1434
1435 /* Copy object attributes. */
1436 _bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
1437
1438 if (iheaders == NULL || oheaders == NULL)
1439 return TRUE;
1440
1441 bed = get_elf_backend_data (obfd);
1442
1443 /* Possibly copy other fields in the section header. */
1444 for (i = 1; i < elf_numsections (obfd); i++)
1445 {
1446 unsigned int j;
1447 Elf_Internal_Shdr * oheader = oheaders[i];
1448
1449 /* Ignore ordinary sections. SHT_NOBITS sections are considered however
1450 because of a special case need for generating separate debug info
1451 files. See below for more details. */
1452 if (oheader == NULL
1453 || (oheader->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
1454 && oheader->sh_type < SHT_LOOS))
1455 continue;
1456
1457 /* Ignore empty sections, and sections whose
1458 fields have already been initialised. */
1459 if (oheader->sh_size == 0
1460 || (oheader->sh_info != 0 && oheader->sh_link != 0))
1461 continue;
1462
1463 /* Scan for the matching section in the input bfd.
1464 First we try for a direct mapping between the input and output sections. */
1465 for (j = 1; j < elf_numsections (ibfd); j++)
1466 {
1467 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * iheader = iheaders[j];
1468
1469 if (iheader == NULL)
1470 continue;
1471
1472 if (oheader->bfd_section != NULL
1473 && iheader->bfd_section != NULL
1474 && iheader->bfd_section->output_section != NULL
1475 && iheader->bfd_section->output_section == oheader->bfd_section)
1476 {
1477 /* We have found a connection from the input section to the
1478 output section. Attempt to copy the header fields. If
1479 this fails then do not try any further sections - there
1480 should only be a one-to-one mapping between input and output. */
1481 if (! copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader, i))
1482 j = elf_numsections (ibfd);
1483 break;
1484 }
1485 }
1486
1487 if (j < elf_numsections (ibfd))
1488 continue;
1489
1490 /* That failed. So try to deduce the corresponding input section.
1491 Unfortunately we cannot compare names as the output string table
1492 is empty, so instead we check size, address and type. */
1493 for (j = 1; j < elf_numsections (ibfd); j++)
1494 {
1495 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * iheader = iheaders[j];
1496
1497 if (iheader == NULL)
1498 continue;
1499
1500 /* Try matching fields in the input section's header.
1501 Since --only-keep-debug turns all non-debug sections into
1502 SHT_NOBITS sections, the output SHT_NOBITS type matches any
1503 input type. */
1504 if ((oheader->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
1505 || iheader->sh_type == oheader->sh_type)
1506 && (iheader->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1507 == (oheader->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1508 && iheader->sh_addralign == oheader->sh_addralign
1509 && iheader->sh_entsize == oheader->sh_entsize
1510 && iheader->sh_size == oheader->sh_size
1511 && iheader->sh_addr == oheader->sh_addr
1512 && (iheader->sh_info != oheader->sh_info
1513 || iheader->sh_link != oheader->sh_link))
1514 {
1515 if (copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader, i))
1516 break;
1517 }
1518 }
1519
1520 if (j == elf_numsections (ibfd) && oheader->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS)
1521 {
1522 /* Final attempt. Call the backend copy function
1523 with a NULL input section. */
1524 if (bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields != NULL)
1525 bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, NULL, oheader);
1526 }
1527 }
1528
1529 return TRUE;
1530 }
1531
1532 static const char *
1533 get_segment_type (unsigned int p_type)
1534 {
1535 const char *pt;
1536 switch (p_type)
1537 {
1538 case PT_NULL: pt = "NULL"; break;
1539 case PT_LOAD: pt = "LOAD"; break;
1540 case PT_DYNAMIC: pt = "DYNAMIC"; break;
1541 case PT_INTERP: pt = "INTERP"; break;
1542 case PT_NOTE: pt = "NOTE"; break;
1543 case PT_SHLIB: pt = "SHLIB"; break;
1544 case PT_PHDR: pt = "PHDR"; break;
1545 case PT_TLS: pt = "TLS"; break;
1546 case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME: pt = "EH_FRAME"; break;
1547 case PT_GNU_STACK: pt = "STACK"; break;
1548 case PT_GNU_RELRO: pt = "RELRO"; break;
1549 default: pt = NULL; break;
1550 }
1551 return pt;
1552 }
1553
1554 /* Print out the program headers. */
1555
1556 bfd_boolean
1557 _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *farg)
1558 {
1559 FILE *f = (FILE *) farg;
1560 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
1561 asection *s;
1562 bfd_byte *dynbuf = NULL;
1563
1564 p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1565 if (p != NULL)
1566 {
1567 unsigned int i, c;
1568
1569 fprintf (f, _("\nProgram Header:\n"));
1570 c = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
1571 for (i = 0; i < c; i++, p++)
1572 {
1573 const char *pt = get_segment_type (p->p_type);
1574 char buf[20];
1575
1576 if (pt == NULL)
1577 {
1578 sprintf (buf, "0x%lx", p->p_type);
1579 pt = buf;
1580 }
1581 fprintf (f, "%8s off 0x", pt);
1582 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_offset);
1583 fprintf (f, " vaddr 0x");
1584 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_vaddr);
1585 fprintf (f, " paddr 0x");
1586 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_paddr);
1587 fprintf (f, " align 2**%u\n", bfd_log2 (p->p_align));
1588 fprintf (f, " filesz 0x");
1589 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_filesz);
1590 fprintf (f, " memsz 0x");
1591 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_memsz);
1592 fprintf (f, " flags %c%c%c",
1593 (p->p_flags & PF_R) != 0 ? 'r' : '-',
1594 (p->p_flags & PF_W) != 0 ? 'w' : '-',
1595 (p->p_flags & PF_X) != 0 ? 'x' : '-');
1596 if ((p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X)) != 0)
1597 fprintf (f, " %lx", p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X));
1598 fprintf (f, "\n");
1599 }
1600 }
1601
1602 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1603 if (s != NULL)
1604 {
1605 unsigned int elfsec;
1606 unsigned long shlink;
1607 bfd_byte *extdyn, *extdynend;
1608 size_t extdynsize;
1609 void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1610
1611 fprintf (f, _("\nDynamic Section:\n"));
1612
1613 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &dynbuf))
1614 goto error_return;
1615
1616 elfsec = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, s);
1617 if (elfsec == SHN_BAD)
1618 goto error_return;
1619 shlink = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec]->sh_link;
1620
1621 extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1622 swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1623
1624 extdyn = dynbuf;
1625 /* PR 17512: file: 6f427532. */
1626 if (s->size < extdynsize)
1627 goto error_return;
1628 extdynend = extdyn + s->size;
1629 /* PR 17512: file: id:000006,sig:06,src:000000,op:flip4,pos:5664.
1630 Fix range check. */
1631 for (; extdyn <= (extdynend - extdynsize); extdyn += extdynsize)
1632 {
1633 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1634 const char *name = "";
1635 char ab[20];
1636 bfd_boolean stringp;
1637 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1638
1639 (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1640
1641 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1642 break;
1643
1644 stringp = FALSE;
1645 switch (dyn.d_tag)
1646 {
1647 default:
1648 if (bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag)
1649 name = (*bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag) (dyn.d_tag);
1650
1651 if (!strcmp (name, ""))
1652 {
1653 sprintf (ab, "0x%lx", (unsigned long) dyn.d_tag);
1654 name = ab;
1655 }
1656 break;
1657
1658 case DT_NEEDED: name = "NEEDED"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1659 case DT_PLTRELSZ: name = "PLTRELSZ"; break;
1660 case DT_PLTGOT: name = "PLTGOT"; break;
1661 case DT_HASH: name = "HASH"; break;
1662 case DT_STRTAB: name = "STRTAB"; break;
1663 case DT_SYMTAB: name = "SYMTAB"; break;
1664 case DT_RELA: name = "RELA"; break;
1665 case DT_RELASZ: name = "RELASZ"; break;
1666 case DT_RELAENT: name = "RELAENT"; break;
1667 case DT_STRSZ: name = "STRSZ"; break;
1668 case DT_SYMENT: name = "SYMENT"; break;
1669 case DT_INIT: name = "INIT"; break;
1670 case DT_FINI: name = "FINI"; break;
1671 case DT_SONAME: name = "SONAME"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1672 case DT_RPATH: name = "RPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1673 case DT_SYMBOLIC: name = "SYMBOLIC"; break;
1674 case DT_REL: name = "REL"; break;
1675 case DT_RELSZ: name = "RELSZ"; break;
1676 case DT_RELENT: name = "RELENT"; break;
1677 case DT_PLTREL: name = "PLTREL"; break;
1678 case DT_DEBUG: name = "DEBUG"; break;
1679 case DT_TEXTREL: name = "TEXTREL"; break;
1680 case DT_JMPREL: name = "JMPREL"; break;
1681 case DT_BIND_NOW: name = "BIND_NOW"; break;
1682 case DT_INIT_ARRAY: name = "INIT_ARRAY"; break;
1683 case DT_FINI_ARRAY: name = "FINI_ARRAY"; break;
1684 case DT_INIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "INIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1685 case DT_FINI_ARRAYSZ: name = "FINI_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1686 case DT_RUNPATH: name = "RUNPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1687 case DT_FLAGS: name = "FLAGS"; break;
1688 case DT_PREINIT_ARRAY: name = "PREINIT_ARRAY"; break;
1689 case DT_PREINIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "PREINIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1690 case DT_CHECKSUM: name = "CHECKSUM"; break;
1691 case DT_PLTPADSZ: name = "PLTPADSZ"; break;
1692 case DT_MOVEENT: name = "MOVEENT"; break;
1693 case DT_MOVESZ: name = "MOVESZ"; break;
1694 case DT_FEATURE: name = "FEATURE"; break;
1695 case DT_POSFLAG_1: name = "POSFLAG_1"; break;
1696 case DT_SYMINSZ: name = "SYMINSZ"; break;
1697 case DT_SYMINENT: name = "SYMINENT"; break;
1698 case DT_CONFIG: name = "CONFIG"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1699 case DT_DEPAUDIT: name = "DEPAUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1700 case DT_AUDIT: name = "AUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1701 case DT_PLTPAD: name = "PLTPAD"; break;
1702 case DT_MOVETAB: name = "MOVETAB"; break;
1703 case DT_SYMINFO: name = "SYMINFO"; break;
1704 case DT_RELACOUNT: name = "RELACOUNT"; break;
1705 case DT_RELCOUNT: name = "RELCOUNT"; break;
1706 case DT_FLAGS_1: name = "FLAGS_1"; break;
1707 case DT_VERSYM: name = "VERSYM"; break;
1708 case DT_VERDEF: name = "VERDEF"; break;
1709 case DT_VERDEFNUM: name = "VERDEFNUM"; break;
1710 case DT_VERNEED: name = "VERNEED"; break;
1711 case DT_VERNEEDNUM: name = "VERNEEDNUM"; break;
1712 case DT_AUXILIARY: name = "AUXILIARY"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1713 case DT_USED: name = "USED"; break;
1714 case DT_FILTER: name = "FILTER"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1715 case DT_GNU_HASH: name = "GNU_HASH"; break;
1716 }
1717
1718 fprintf (f, " %-20s ", name);
1719 if (! stringp)
1720 {
1721 fprintf (f, "0x");
1722 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, dyn.d_un.d_val);
1723 }
1724 else
1725 {
1726 const char *string;
1727 unsigned int tagv = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1728
1729 string = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shlink, tagv);
1730 if (string == NULL)
1731 goto error_return;
1732 fprintf (f, "%s", string);
1733 }
1734 fprintf (f, "\n");
1735 }
1736
1737 free (dynbuf);
1738 dynbuf = NULL;
1739 }
1740
1741 if ((elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
1742 || (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL))
1743 {
1744 if (! _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (abfd, FALSE))
1745 return FALSE;
1746 }
1747
1748 if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
1749 {
1750 Elf_Internal_Verdef *t;
1751
1752 fprintf (f, _("\nVersion definitions:\n"));
1753 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef; t != NULL; t = t->vd_nextdef)
1754 {
1755 fprintf (f, "%d 0x%2.2x 0x%8.8lx %s\n", t->vd_ndx,
1756 t->vd_flags, t->vd_hash,
1757 t->vd_nodename ? t->vd_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1758 if (t->vd_auxptr != NULL && t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr != NULL)
1759 {
1760 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *a;
1761
1762 fprintf (f, "\t");
1763 for (a = t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr;
1764 a != NULL;
1765 a = a->vda_nextptr)
1766 fprintf (f, "%s ",
1767 a->vda_nodename ? a->vda_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1768 fprintf (f, "\n");
1769 }
1770 }
1771 }
1772
1773 if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
1774 {
1775 Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1776
1777 fprintf (f, _("\nVersion References:\n"));
1778 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref; t != NULL; t = t->vn_nextref)
1779 {
1780 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1781
1782 fprintf (f, _(" required from %s:\n"),
1783 t->vn_filename ? t->vn_filename : "<corrupt>");
1784 for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1785 fprintf (f, " 0x%8.8lx 0x%2.2x %2.2d %s\n", a->vna_hash,
1786 a->vna_flags, a->vna_other,
1787 a->vna_nodename ? a->vna_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1788 }
1789 }
1790
1791 return TRUE;
1792
1793 error_return:
1794 if (dynbuf != NULL)
1795 free (dynbuf);
1796 return FALSE;
1797 }
1798
1799 /* Get version string. */
1800
1801 const char *
1802 _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (bfd *abfd, asymbol *symbol,
1803 bfd_boolean *hidden)
1804 {
1805 const char *version_string = NULL;
1806 if (elf_dynversym (abfd) != 0
1807 && (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 || elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0))
1808 {
1809 unsigned int vernum = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->version;
1810
1811 *hidden = (vernum & VERSYM_HIDDEN) != 0;
1812 vernum &= VERSYM_VERSION;
1813
1814 if (vernum == 0)
1815 version_string = "";
1816 else if (vernum == 1)
1817 version_string = "Base";
1818 else if (vernum <= elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs)
1819 version_string =
1820 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[vernum - 1].vd_nodename;
1821 else
1822 {
1823 Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1824
1825 version_string = "";
1826 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
1827 t != NULL;
1828 t = t->vn_nextref)
1829 {
1830 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1831
1832 for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1833 {
1834 if (a->vna_other == vernum)
1835 {
1836 version_string = a->vna_nodename;
1837 break;
1838 }
1839 }
1840 }
1841 }
1842 }
1843 return version_string;
1844 }
1845
1846 /* Display ELF-specific fields of a symbol. */
1847
1848 void
1849 bfd_elf_print_symbol (bfd *abfd,
1850 void *filep,
1851 asymbol *symbol,
1852 bfd_print_symbol_type how)
1853 {
1854 FILE *file = (FILE *) filep;
1855 switch (how)
1856 {
1857 case bfd_print_symbol_name:
1858 fprintf (file, "%s", symbol->name);
1859 break;
1860 case bfd_print_symbol_more:
1861 fprintf (file, "elf ");
1862 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, symbol->value);
1863 fprintf (file, " %lx", (unsigned long) symbol->flags);
1864 break;
1865 case bfd_print_symbol_all:
1866 {
1867 const char *section_name;
1868 const char *name = NULL;
1869 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1870 unsigned char st_other;
1871 bfd_vma val;
1872 const char *version_string;
1873 bfd_boolean hidden;
1874
1875 section_name = symbol->section ? symbol->section->name : "(*none*)";
1876
1877 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1878 if (bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all)
1879 name = (*bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all) (abfd, filep, symbol);
1880
1881 if (name == NULL)
1882 {
1883 name = symbol->name;
1884 bfd_print_symbol_vandf (abfd, file, symbol);
1885 }
1886
1887 fprintf (file, " %s\t", section_name);
1888 /* Print the "other" value for a symbol. For common symbols,
1889 we've already printed the size; now print the alignment.
1890 For other symbols, we have no specified alignment, and
1891 we've printed the address; now print the size. */
1892 if (symbol->section && bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1893 val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
1894 else
1895 val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
1896 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, val);
1897
1898 /* If we have version information, print it. */
1899 version_string = _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (abfd,
1900 symbol,
1901 &hidden);
1902 if (version_string)
1903 {
1904 if (!hidden)
1905 fprintf (file, " %-11s", version_string);
1906 else
1907 {
1908 int i;
1909
1910 fprintf (file, " (%s)", version_string);
1911 for (i = 10 - strlen (version_string); i > 0; --i)
1912 putc (' ', file);
1913 }
1914 }
1915
1916 /* If the st_other field is not zero, print it. */
1917 st_other = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
1918
1919 switch (st_other)
1920 {
1921 case 0: break;
1922 case STV_INTERNAL: fprintf (file, " .internal"); break;
1923 case STV_HIDDEN: fprintf (file, " .hidden"); break;
1924 case STV_PROTECTED: fprintf (file, " .protected"); break;
1925 default:
1926 /* Some other non-defined flags are also present, so print
1927 everything hex. */
1928 fprintf (file, " 0x%02x", (unsigned int) st_other);
1929 }
1930
1931 fprintf (file, " %s", name);
1932 }
1933 break;
1934 }
1935 }
1936 \f
1937 /* ELF .o/exec file reading */
1938
1939 /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF section header. */
1940
1941 bfd_boolean
1942 bfd_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
1943 {
1944 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
1945 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *ehdr;
1946 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1947 const char *name;
1948 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
1949 static bfd_boolean * sections_being_created = NULL;
1950 static bfd * sections_being_created_abfd = NULL;
1951 static unsigned int nesting = 0;
1952
1953 if (shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
1954 return FALSE;
1955
1956 if (++ nesting > 3)
1957 {
1958 /* PR17512: A corrupt ELF binary might contain a recursive group of
1959 sections, with each the string indicies pointing to the next in the
1960 loop. Detect this here, by refusing to load a section that we are
1961 already in the process of loading. We only trigger this test if
1962 we have nested at least three sections deep as normal ELF binaries
1963 can expect to recurse at least once.
1964
1965 FIXME: It would be better if this array was attached to the bfd,
1966 rather than being held in a static pointer. */
1967
1968 if (sections_being_created_abfd != abfd)
1969 sections_being_created = NULL;
1970 if (sections_being_created == NULL)
1971 {
1972 /* FIXME: It would be more efficient to attach this array to the bfd somehow. */
1973 sections_being_created = (bfd_boolean *)
1974 bfd_zalloc (abfd, elf_numsections (abfd) * sizeof (bfd_boolean));
1975 sections_being_created_abfd = abfd;
1976 }
1977 if (sections_being_created [shindex])
1978 {
1979 _bfd_error_handler
1980 (_("%B: warning: loop in section dependencies detected"), abfd);
1981 return FALSE;
1982 }
1983 sections_being_created [shindex] = TRUE;
1984 }
1985
1986 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
1987 ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
1988 name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, ehdr->e_shstrndx,
1989 hdr->sh_name);
1990 if (name == NULL)
1991 goto fail;
1992
1993 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1994 switch (hdr->sh_type)
1995 {
1996 case SHT_NULL:
1997 /* Inactive section. Throw it away. */
1998 goto success;
1999
2000 case SHT_PROGBITS: /* Normal section with contents. */
2001 case SHT_NOBITS: /* .bss section. */
2002 case SHT_HASH: /* .hash section. */
2003 case SHT_NOTE: /* .note section. */
2004 case SHT_INIT_ARRAY: /* .init_array section. */
2005 case SHT_FINI_ARRAY: /* .fini_array section. */
2006 case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY: /* .preinit_array section. */
2007 case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST: /* .gnu.liblist section. */
2008 case SHT_GNU_HASH: /* .gnu.hash section. */
2009 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2010 goto success;
2011
2012 case SHT_DYNAMIC: /* Dynamic linking information. */
2013 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2014 goto fail;
2015
2016 if (hdr->sh_link > elf_numsections (abfd))
2017 {
2018 /* PR 10478: Accept Solaris binaries with a sh_link
2019 field set to SHN_BEFORE or SHN_AFTER. */
2020 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
2021 {
2022 case bfd_arch_i386:
2023 case bfd_arch_sparc:
2024 if (hdr->sh_link == (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xffff) /* SHN_BEFORE */
2025 || hdr->sh_link == ((SHN_LORESERVE + 1) & 0xffff) /* SHN_AFTER */)
2026 break;
2027 /* Otherwise fall through. */
2028 default:
2029 goto fail;
2030 }
2031 }
2032 else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link] == NULL)
2033 goto fail;
2034 else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB)
2035 {
2036 Elf_Internal_Shdr *dynsymhdr;
2037
2038 /* The shared libraries distributed with hpux11 have a bogus
2039 sh_link field for the ".dynamic" section. Find the
2040 string table for the ".dynsym" section instead. */
2041 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
2042 {
2043 dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)];
2044 hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
2045 }
2046 else
2047 {
2048 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2049
2050 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2051 for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2052 {
2053 dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2054 if (dynsymhdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2055 {
2056 hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
2057 break;
2058 }
2059 }
2060 }
2061 }
2062 goto success;
2063
2064 case SHT_SYMTAB: /* A symbol table. */
2065 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == shindex)
2066 goto success;
2067
2068 if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
2069 goto fail;
2070
2071 if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
2072 {
2073 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2074 goto fail;
2075 /* Some assemblers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
2076 zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
2077 of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
2078 hdr->sh_info = 0;
2079 goto success;
2080 }
2081
2082 /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one symbol table.
2083 Unusual, but possible. Warn, but continue. */
2084 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) != 0)
2085 {
2086 _bfd_error_handler
2087 /* xgettext:c-format */
2088 (_("%B: warning: multiple symbol tables detected - ignoring the table in section %u"),
2089 abfd, shindex);
2090 goto success;
2091 }
2092 elf_onesymtab (abfd) = shindex;
2093 elf_symtab_hdr (abfd) = *hdr;
2094 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
2095 abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
2096
2097 /* Sometimes a shared object will map in the symbol table. If
2098 SHF_ALLOC is set, and this is a shared object, then we also
2099 treat this section as a BFD section. We can not base the
2100 decision purely on SHF_ALLOC, because that flag is sometimes
2101 set in a relocatable object file, which would confuse the
2102 linker. */
2103 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
2104 && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
2105 && ! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2106 shindex))
2107 goto fail;
2108
2109 /* Go looking for SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX too, since if there is one we
2110 can't read symbols without that section loaded as well. It
2111 is most likely specified by the next section header. */
2112 {
2113 elf_section_list * entry;
2114 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2115
2116 for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
2117 if (entry->hdr.sh_link == shindex)
2118 goto success;
2119
2120 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2121 for (i = shindex + 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2122 {
2123 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2124
2125 if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
2126 && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2127 break;
2128 }
2129
2130 if (i == num_sec)
2131 for (i = 1; i < shindex; i++)
2132 {
2133 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2134
2135 if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
2136 && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2137 break;
2138 }
2139
2140 if (i != shindex)
2141 ret = bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i);
2142 /* else FIXME: we have failed to find the symbol table - should we issue an error ? */
2143 goto success;
2144 }
2145
2146 case SHT_DYNSYM: /* A dynamic symbol table. */
2147 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == shindex)
2148 goto success;
2149
2150 if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
2151 goto fail;
2152
2153 if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
2154 {
2155 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2156 goto fail;
2157
2158 /* Some linkers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
2159 zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
2160 of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
2161 hdr->sh_info = 0;
2162 goto success;
2163 }
2164
2165 /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one dynamic symbol table.
2166 Unusual, but possible. Warn, but continue. */
2167 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
2168 {
2169 _bfd_error_handler
2170 /* xgettext:c-format */
2171 (_("%B: warning: multiple dynamic symbol tables detected - ignoring the table in section %u"),
2172 abfd, shindex);
2173 goto success;
2174 }
2175 elf_dynsymtab (abfd) = shindex;
2176 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr = *hdr;
2177 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
2178 abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
2179
2180 /* Besides being a symbol table, we also treat this as a regular
2181 section, so that objcopy can handle it. */
2182 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2183 goto success;
2184
2185 case SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX: /* Symbol section indices when >64k sections. */
2186 {
2187 elf_section_list * entry;
2188
2189 for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
2190 if (entry->ndx == shindex)
2191 goto success;
2192
2193 entry = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof * entry);
2194 if (entry == NULL)
2195 goto fail;
2196 entry->ndx = shindex;
2197 entry->hdr = * hdr;
2198 entry->next = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd);
2199 elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) = entry;
2200 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = & entry->hdr;
2201 goto success;
2202 }
2203
2204 case SHT_STRTAB: /* A string table. */
2205 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
2206 goto success;
2207
2208 if (ehdr->e_shstrndx == shindex)
2209 {
2210 elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
2211 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
2212 goto success;
2213 }
2214
2215 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
2216 {
2217 symtab_strtab:
2218 elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr = *hdr;
2219 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
2220 goto success;
2221 }
2222
2223 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
2224 {
2225 dynsymtab_strtab:
2226 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
2227 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr;
2228 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr;
2229 /* We also treat this as a regular section, so that objcopy
2230 can handle it. */
2231 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2232 shindex);
2233 goto success;
2234 }
2235
2236 /* If the string table isn't one of the above, then treat it as a
2237 regular section. We need to scan all the headers to be sure,
2238 just in case this strtab section appeared before the above. */
2239 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == 0 || elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
2240 {
2241 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2242
2243 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2244 for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2245 {
2246 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2247 if (hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2248 {
2249 /* Prevent endless recursion on broken objects. */
2250 if (i == shindex)
2251 goto fail;
2252 if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i))
2253 goto fail;
2254 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == i)
2255 goto symtab_strtab;
2256 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == i)
2257 goto dynsymtab_strtab;
2258 }
2259 }
2260 }
2261 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2262 goto success;
2263
2264 case SHT_REL:
2265 case SHT_RELA:
2266 /* *These* do a lot of work -- but build no sections! */
2267 {
2268 asection *target_sect;
2269 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2, **p_hdr;
2270 unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2271 struct bfd_elf_section_data *esdt;
2272
2273 if (hdr->sh_entsize
2274 != (bfd_size_type) (hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL
2275 ? bed->s->sizeof_rel : bed->s->sizeof_rela))
2276 goto fail;
2277
2278 /* Check for a bogus link to avoid crashing. */
2279 if (hdr->sh_link >= num_sec)
2280 {
2281 _bfd_error_handler
2282 /* xgettext:c-format */
2283 (_("%B: invalid link %lu for reloc section %s (index %u)"),
2284 abfd, hdr->sh_link, name, shindex);
2285 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2286 shindex);
2287 goto success;
2288 }
2289
2290 /* For some incomprehensible reason Oracle distributes
2291 libraries for Solaris in which some of the objects have
2292 bogus sh_link fields. It would be nice if we could just
2293 reject them, but, unfortunately, some people need to use
2294 them. We scan through the section headers; if we find only
2295 one suitable symbol table, we clobber the sh_link to point
2296 to it. I hope this doesn't break anything.
2297
2298 Don't do it on executable nor shared library. */
2299 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0
2300 && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
2301 && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_DYNSYM)
2302 {
2303 unsigned int scan;
2304 int found;
2305
2306 found = 0;
2307 for (scan = 1; scan < num_sec; scan++)
2308 {
2309 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
2310 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2311 {
2312 if (found != 0)
2313 {
2314 found = 0;
2315 break;
2316 }
2317 found = scan;
2318 }
2319 }
2320 if (found != 0)
2321 hdr->sh_link = found;
2322 }
2323
2324 /* Get the symbol table. */
2325 if ((elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
2326 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2327 && ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_link))
2328 goto fail;
2329
2330 /* If this reloc section does not use the main symbol table we
2331 don't treat it as a reloc section. BFD can't adequately
2332 represent such a section, so at least for now, we don't
2333 try. We just present it as a normal section. We also
2334 can't use it as a reloc section if it points to the null
2335 section, an invalid section, another reloc section, or its
2336 sh_link points to the null section. */
2337 if (hdr->sh_link != elf_onesymtab (abfd)
2338 || hdr->sh_link == SHN_UNDEF
2339 || hdr->sh_info == SHN_UNDEF
2340 || hdr->sh_info >= num_sec
2341 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_REL
2342 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2343 {
2344 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2345 shindex);
2346 goto success;
2347 }
2348
2349 if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_info))
2350 goto fail;
2351
2352 target_sect = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, hdr->sh_info);
2353 if (target_sect == NULL)
2354 goto fail;
2355
2356 esdt = elf_section_data (target_sect);
2357 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2358 p_hdr = &esdt->rela.hdr;
2359 else
2360 p_hdr = &esdt->rel.hdr;
2361
2362 /* PR 17512: file: 0b4f81b7. */
2363 if (*p_hdr != NULL)
2364 goto fail;
2365 hdr2 = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (*hdr2));
2366 if (hdr2 == NULL)
2367 goto fail;
2368 *hdr2 = *hdr;
2369 *p_hdr = hdr2;
2370 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr2;
2371 target_sect->reloc_count += NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (hdr);
2372 target_sect->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
2373 target_sect->relocation = NULL;
2374 target_sect->rel_filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
2375 /* In the section to which the relocations apply, mark whether
2376 its relocations are of the REL or RELA variety. */
2377 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2378 {
2379 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2380 target_sect->use_rela_p = 1;
2381 }
2382 abfd->flags |= HAS_RELOC;
2383 goto success;
2384 }
2385
2386 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
2387 elf_dynverdef (abfd) = shindex;
2388 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr = *hdr;
2389 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2390 goto success;
2391
2392 case SHT_GNU_versym:
2393 if (hdr->sh_entsize != sizeof (Elf_External_Versym))
2394 goto fail;
2395
2396 elf_dynversym (abfd) = shindex;
2397 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynversym_hdr = *hdr;
2398 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2399 goto success;
2400
2401 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
2402 elf_dynverref (abfd) = shindex;
2403 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr = *hdr;
2404 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2405 goto success;
2406
2407 case SHT_SHLIB:
2408 goto success;
2409
2410 case SHT_GROUP:
2411 if (! IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (hdr, GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
2412 goto fail;
2413
2414 if (!_bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2415 goto fail;
2416
2417 if (hdr->contents != NULL)
2418 {
2419 Elf_Internal_Group *idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) hdr->contents;
2420 unsigned int n_elt = hdr->sh_size / sizeof (* idx);
2421 asection *s;
2422
2423 if (n_elt == 0)
2424 goto fail;
2425 if (idx->flags & GRP_COMDAT)
2426 hdr->bfd_section->flags
2427 |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
2428
2429 /* We try to keep the same section order as it comes in. */
2430 idx += n_elt;
2431
2432 while (--n_elt != 0)
2433 {
2434 --idx;
2435
2436 if (idx->shdr != NULL
2437 && (s = idx->shdr->bfd_section) != NULL
2438 && elf_next_in_group (s) != NULL)
2439 {
2440 elf_next_in_group (hdr->bfd_section) = s;
2441 break;
2442 }
2443 }
2444 }
2445 goto success;
2446
2447 default:
2448 /* Possibly an attributes section. */
2449 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_ATTRIBUTES
2450 || hdr->sh_type == bed->obj_attrs_section_type)
2451 {
2452 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2453 goto fail;
2454 _bfd_elf_parse_attributes (abfd, hdr);
2455 goto success;
2456 }
2457
2458 /* Check for any processor-specific section types. */
2459 if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2460 goto success;
2461
2462 if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOUSER && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIUSER)
2463 {
2464 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
2465 /* FIXME: How to properly handle allocated section reserved
2466 for applications? */
2467 _bfd_error_handler
2468 /* xgettext:c-format */
2469 (_("%B: don't know how to handle allocated, application "
2470 "specific section `%s' [0x%8x]"),
2471 abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
2472 else
2473 {
2474 /* Allow sections reserved for applications. */
2475 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2476 shindex);
2477 goto success;
2478 }
2479 }
2480 else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOPROC
2481 && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIPROC)
2482 /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2483 _bfd_error_handler
2484 /* xgettext:c-format */
2485 (_("%B: don't know how to handle processor specific section "
2486 "`%s' [0x%8x]"),
2487 abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
2488 else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIOS)
2489 {
2490 /* Unrecognised OS-specific sections. */
2491 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING) != 0)
2492 /* SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING indicates that special knowledge is
2493 required to correctly process the section and the file should
2494 be rejected with an error message. */
2495 _bfd_error_handler
2496 /* xgettext:c-format */
2497 (_("%B: don't know how to handle OS specific section "
2498 "`%s' [0x%8x]"),
2499 abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
2500 else
2501 {
2502 /* Otherwise it should be processed. */
2503 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2504 goto success;
2505 }
2506 }
2507 else
2508 /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2509 _bfd_error_handler
2510 /* xgettext:c-format */
2511 (_("%B: don't know how to handle section `%s' [0x%8x]"),
2512 abfd, name, hdr->sh_type);
2513
2514 goto fail;
2515 }
2516
2517 fail:
2518 ret = FALSE;
2519 success:
2520 if (sections_being_created && sections_being_created_abfd == abfd)
2521 sections_being_created [shindex] = FALSE;
2522 if (-- nesting == 0)
2523 {
2524 sections_being_created = NULL;
2525 sections_being_created_abfd = abfd;
2526 }
2527 return ret;
2528 }
2529
2530 /* Return the local symbol specified by ABFD, R_SYMNDX. */
2531
2532 Elf_Internal_Sym *
2533 bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (struct sym_cache *cache,
2534 bfd *abfd,
2535 unsigned long r_symndx)
2536 {
2537 unsigned int ent = r_symndx % LOCAL_SYM_CACHE_SIZE;
2538
2539 if (cache->abfd != abfd || cache->indx[ent] != r_symndx)
2540 {
2541 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2542 unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
2543 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
2544
2545 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
2546 if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr, 1, r_symndx,
2547 &cache->sym[ent], esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
2548 return NULL;
2549
2550 if (cache->abfd != abfd)
2551 {
2552 memset (cache->indx, -1, sizeof (cache->indx));
2553 cache->abfd = abfd;
2554 }
2555 cache->indx[ent] = r_symndx;
2556 }
2557
2558 return &cache->sym[ent];
2559 }
2560
2561 /* Given an ELF section number, retrieve the corresponding BFD
2562 section. */
2563
2564 asection *
2565 bfd_section_from_elf_index (bfd *abfd, unsigned int sec_index)
2566 {
2567 if (sec_index >= elf_numsections (abfd))
2568 return NULL;
2569 return elf_elfsections (abfd)[sec_index]->bfd_section;
2570 }
2571
2572 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_b[] =
2573 {
2574 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".bss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2575 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2576 };
2577
2578 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_c[] =
2579 {
2580 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".comment"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2581 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2582 };
2583
2584 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_d[] =
2585 {
2586 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2587 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2588 /* There are more DWARF sections than these, but they needn't be added here
2589 unless you have to cope with broken compilers that don't emit section
2590 attributes or you want to help the user writing assembler. */
2591 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2592 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2593 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2594 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2595 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2596 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynamic"), 0, SHT_DYNAMIC, SHF_ALLOC },
2597 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynstr"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, SHF_ALLOC },
2598 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynsym"), 0, SHT_DYNSYM, SHF_ALLOC },
2599 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2600 };
2601
2602 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_f[] =
2603 {
2604 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2605 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini_array"), 0, SHT_FINI_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2606 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2607 };
2608
2609 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_g[] =
2610 {
2611 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.linkonce.b"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2612 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.lto_"), -1, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_EXCLUDE },
2613 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".got"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2614 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version"), 0, SHT_GNU_versym, 0 },
2615 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_d"), 0, SHT_GNU_verdef, 0 },
2616 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_r"), 0, SHT_GNU_verneed, 0 },
2617 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.liblist"), 0, SHT_GNU_LIBLIST, SHF_ALLOC },
2618 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.conflict"), 0, SHT_RELA, SHF_ALLOC },
2619 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.hash"), 0, SHT_GNU_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2620 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2621 };
2622
2623 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_h[] =
2624 {
2625 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".hash"), 0, SHT_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2626 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2627 };
2628
2629 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_i[] =
2630 {
2631 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2632 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init_array"), 0, SHT_INIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2633 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".interp"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2634 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2635 };
2636
2637 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_l[] =
2638 {
2639 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2640 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2641 };
2642
2643 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_n[] =
2644 {
2645 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note.GNU-stack"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2646 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note"), -1, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
2647 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2648 };
2649
2650 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_p[] =
2651 {
2652 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".preinit_array"), 0, SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2653 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2654 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2655 };
2656
2657 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_r[] =
2658 {
2659 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2660 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2661 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rela"), -1, SHT_RELA, 0 },
2662 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rel"), -1, SHT_REL, 0 },
2663 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2664 };
2665
2666 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_s[] =
2667 {
2668 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".shstrtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2669 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".strtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2670 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".symtab"), 0, SHT_SYMTAB, 0 },
2671 /* See struct bfd_elf_special_section declaration for the semantics of
2672 this special case where .prefix_length != strlen (.prefix). */
2673 { ".stabstr", 5, 3, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2674 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2675 };
2676
2677 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_t[] =
2678 {
2679 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".text"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2680 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2681 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2682 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2683 };
2684
2685 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_z[] =
2686 {
2687 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2688 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2689 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2690 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2691 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2692 };
2693
2694 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section * const special_sections[] =
2695 {
2696 special_sections_b, /* 'b' */
2697 special_sections_c, /* 'c' */
2698 special_sections_d, /* 'd' */
2699 NULL, /* 'e' */
2700 special_sections_f, /* 'f' */
2701 special_sections_g, /* 'g' */
2702 special_sections_h, /* 'h' */
2703 special_sections_i, /* 'i' */
2704 NULL, /* 'j' */
2705 NULL, /* 'k' */
2706 special_sections_l, /* 'l' */
2707 NULL, /* 'm' */
2708 special_sections_n, /* 'n' */
2709 NULL, /* 'o' */
2710 special_sections_p, /* 'p' */
2711 NULL, /* 'q' */
2712 special_sections_r, /* 'r' */
2713 special_sections_s, /* 's' */
2714 special_sections_t, /* 't' */
2715 NULL, /* 'u' */
2716 NULL, /* 'v' */
2717 NULL, /* 'w' */
2718 NULL, /* 'x' */
2719 NULL, /* 'y' */
2720 special_sections_z /* 'z' */
2721 };
2722
2723 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2724 _bfd_elf_get_special_section (const char *name,
2725 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec,
2726 unsigned int rela)
2727 {
2728 int i;
2729 int len;
2730
2731 len = strlen (name);
2732
2733 for (i = 0; spec[i].prefix != NULL; i++)
2734 {
2735 int suffix_len;
2736 int prefix_len = spec[i].prefix_length;
2737
2738 if (len < prefix_len)
2739 continue;
2740 if (memcmp (name, spec[i].prefix, prefix_len) != 0)
2741 continue;
2742
2743 suffix_len = spec[i].suffix_length;
2744 if (suffix_len <= 0)
2745 {
2746 if (name[prefix_len] != 0)
2747 {
2748 if (suffix_len == 0)
2749 continue;
2750 if (name[prefix_len] != '.'
2751 && (suffix_len == -2
2752 || (rela && spec[i].type == SHT_REL)))
2753 continue;
2754 }
2755 }
2756 else
2757 {
2758 if (len < prefix_len + suffix_len)
2759 continue;
2760 if (memcmp (name + len - suffix_len,
2761 spec[i].prefix + prefix_len,
2762 suffix_len) != 0)
2763 continue;
2764 }
2765 return &spec[i];
2766 }
2767
2768 return NULL;
2769 }
2770
2771 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2772 _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2773 {
2774 int i;
2775 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec;
2776 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2777
2778 /* See if this is one of the special sections. */
2779 if (sec->name == NULL)
2780 return NULL;
2781
2782 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2783 spec = bed->special_sections;
2784 if (spec)
2785 {
2786 spec = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name,
2787 bed->special_sections,
2788 sec->use_rela_p);
2789 if (spec != NULL)
2790 return spec;
2791 }
2792
2793 if (sec->name[0] != '.')
2794 return NULL;
2795
2796 i = sec->name[1] - 'b';
2797 if (i < 0 || i > 'z' - 'b')
2798 return NULL;
2799
2800 spec = special_sections[i];
2801
2802 if (spec == NULL)
2803 return NULL;
2804
2805 return _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, spec, sec->use_rela_p);
2806 }
2807
2808 bfd_boolean
2809 _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2810 {
2811 struct bfd_elf_section_data *sdata;
2812 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2813 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
2814
2815 sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) sec->used_by_bfd;
2816 if (sdata == NULL)
2817 {
2818 sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
2819 sizeof (*sdata));
2820 if (sdata == NULL)
2821 return FALSE;
2822 sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
2823 }
2824
2825 /* Indicate whether or not this section should use RELA relocations. */
2826 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2827 sec->use_rela_p = bed->default_use_rela_p;
2828
2829 /* When we read a file, we don't need to set ELF section type and
2830 flags. They will be overridden in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr
2831 anyway. We will set ELF section type and flags for all linker
2832 created sections. If user specifies BFD section flags, we will
2833 set ELF section type and flags based on BFD section flags in
2834 elf_fake_sections. Special handling for .init_array/.fini_array
2835 output sections since they may contain .ctors/.dtors input
2836 sections. We don't want _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data to
2837 copy ELF section type from .ctors/.dtors input sections. */
2838 if (abfd->direction != read_direction
2839 || (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0)
2840 {
2841 ssect = (*bed->get_sec_type_attr) (abfd, sec);
2842 if (ssect != NULL
2843 && (!sec->flags
2844 || (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
2845 || ssect->type == SHT_INIT_ARRAY
2846 || ssect->type == SHT_FINI_ARRAY))
2847 {
2848 elf_section_type (sec) = ssect->type;
2849 elf_section_flags (sec) = ssect->attr;
2850 }
2851 }
2852
2853 return _bfd_generic_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
2854 }
2855
2856 /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF program header.
2857
2858 Since program segments have no names, we generate a synthetic name
2859 of the form segment<NUM>, where NUM is generally the index in the
2860 program header table. For segments that are split (see below) we
2861 generate the names segment<NUM>a and segment<NUM>b.
2862
2863 Note that some program segments may have a file size that is different than
2864 (less than) the memory size. All this means is that at execution the
2865 system must allocate the amount of memory specified by the memory size,
2866 but only initialize it with the first "file size" bytes read from the
2867 file. This would occur for example, with program segments consisting
2868 of combined data+bss.
2869
2870 To handle the above situation, this routine generates TWO bfd sections
2871 for the single program segment. The first has the length specified by
2872 the file size of the segment, and the second has the length specified
2873 by the difference between the two sizes. In effect, the segment is split
2874 into its initialized and uninitialized parts.
2875
2876 */
2877
2878 bfd_boolean
2879 _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd,
2880 Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr,
2881 int hdr_index,
2882 const char *type_name)
2883 {
2884 asection *newsect;
2885 char *name;
2886 char namebuf[64];
2887 size_t len;
2888 int split;
2889
2890 split = ((hdr->p_memsz > 0)
2891 && (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2892 && (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz));
2893
2894 if (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2895 {
2896 sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "a" : "");
2897 len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2898 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2899 if (!name)
2900 return FALSE;
2901 memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
2902 newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
2903 if (newsect == NULL)
2904 return FALSE;
2905 newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr;
2906 newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr;
2907 newsect->size = hdr->p_filesz;
2908 newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset;
2909 newsect->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
2910 newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (hdr->p_align);
2911 if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
2912 {
2913 newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
2914 newsect->flags |= SEC_LOAD;
2915 if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
2916 {
2917 /* FIXME: all we known is that it has execute PERMISSION,
2918 may be data. */
2919 newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
2920 }
2921 }
2922 if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
2923 {
2924 newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
2925 }
2926 }
2927
2928 if (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz)
2929 {
2930 bfd_vma align;
2931
2932 sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "b" : "");
2933 len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2934 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2935 if (!name)
2936 return FALSE;
2937 memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
2938 newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
2939 if (newsect == NULL)
2940 return FALSE;
2941 newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr + hdr->p_filesz;
2942 newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr + hdr->p_filesz;
2943 newsect->size = hdr->p_memsz - hdr->p_filesz;
2944 newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset + hdr->p_filesz;
2945 align = newsect->vma & -newsect->vma;
2946 if (align == 0 || align > hdr->p_align)
2947 align = hdr->p_align;
2948 newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (align);
2949 if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
2950 {
2951 /* Hack for gdb. Segments that have not been modified do
2952 not have their contents written to a core file, on the
2953 assumption that a debugger can find the contents in the
2954 executable. We flag this case by setting the fake
2955 section size to zero. Note that "real" bss sections will
2956 always have their contents dumped to the core file. */
2957 if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
2958 newsect->size = 0;
2959 newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
2960 if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
2961 newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
2962 }
2963 if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
2964 newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
2965 }
2966
2967 return TRUE;
2968 }
2969
2970 bfd_boolean
2971 bfd_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr, int hdr_index)
2972 {
2973 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2974
2975 switch (hdr->p_type)
2976 {
2977 case PT_NULL:
2978 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "null");
2979
2980 case PT_LOAD:
2981 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "load");
2982
2983 case PT_DYNAMIC:
2984 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "dynamic");
2985
2986 case PT_INTERP:
2987 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "interp");
2988
2989 case PT_NOTE:
2990 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "note"))
2991 return FALSE;
2992 if (! elf_read_notes (abfd, hdr->p_offset, hdr->p_filesz))
2993 return FALSE;
2994 return TRUE;
2995
2996 case PT_SHLIB:
2997 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "shlib");
2998
2999 case PT_PHDR:
3000 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "phdr");
3001
3002 case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME:
3003 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index,
3004 "eh_frame_hdr");
3005
3006 case PT_GNU_STACK:
3007 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "stack");
3008
3009 case PT_GNU_RELRO:
3010 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "relro");
3011
3012 default:
3013 /* Check for any processor-specific program segment types. */
3014 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3015 return bed->elf_backend_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "proc");
3016 }
3017 }
3018
3019 /* Return the REL_HDR for SEC, assuming there is only a single one, either
3020 REL or RELA. */
3021
3022 Elf_Internal_Shdr *
3023 _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (asection *sec)
3024 {
3025 if (elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr)
3026 {
3027 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr == NULL);
3028 return elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr;
3029 }
3030 else
3031 return elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr;
3032 }
3033
3034 static bfd_boolean
3035 _bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (bfd *abfd,
3036 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr,
3037 const char *sec_name,
3038 bfd_boolean use_rela_p)
3039 {
3040 char *name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd,
3041 sizeof ".rela" + strlen (sec_name));
3042 if (name == NULL)
3043 return FALSE;
3044
3045 sprintf (name, "%s%s", use_rela_p ? ".rela" : ".rel", sec_name);
3046 rel_hdr->sh_name =
3047 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd), name,
3048 FALSE);
3049 if (rel_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3050 return FALSE;
3051
3052 return TRUE;
3053 }
3054
3055 /* Allocate and initialize a section-header for a new reloc section,
3056 containing relocations against ASECT. It is stored in RELDATA. If
3057 USE_RELA_P is TRUE, we use RELA relocations; otherwise, we use REL
3058 relocations. */
3059
3060 static bfd_boolean
3061 _bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (bfd *abfd,
3062 struct bfd_elf_section_reloc_data *reldata,
3063 const char *sec_name,
3064 bfd_boolean use_rela_p,
3065 bfd_boolean delay_st_name_p)
3066 {
3067 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
3068 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3069
3070 BFD_ASSERT (reldata->hdr == NULL);
3071 rel_hdr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*rel_hdr));
3072 reldata->hdr = rel_hdr;
3073
3074 if (delay_st_name_p)
3075 rel_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) -1;
3076 else if (!_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd, rel_hdr, sec_name,
3077 use_rela_p))
3078 return FALSE;
3079 rel_hdr->sh_type = use_rela_p ? SHT_RELA : SHT_REL;
3080 rel_hdr->sh_entsize = (use_rela_p
3081 ? bed->s->sizeof_rela
3082 : bed->s->sizeof_rel);
3083 rel_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
3084 rel_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
3085 rel_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
3086 rel_hdr->sh_size = 0;
3087 rel_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
3088
3089 return TRUE;
3090 }
3091
3092 /* Return the default section type based on the passed in section flags. */
3093
3094 int
3095 bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (flagword flags)
3096 {
3097 if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
3098 && (flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
3099 return SHT_NOBITS;
3100 return SHT_PROGBITS;
3101 }
3102
3103 struct fake_section_arg
3104 {
3105 struct bfd_link_info *link_info;
3106 bfd_boolean failed;
3107 };
3108
3109 /* Set up an ELF internal section header for a section. */
3110
3111 static void
3112 elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, asection *asect, void *fsarg)
3113 {
3114 struct fake_section_arg *arg = (struct fake_section_arg *)fsarg;
3115 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3116 struct bfd_elf_section_data *esd = elf_section_data (asect);
3117 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
3118 unsigned int sh_type;
3119 const char *name = asect->name;
3120 bfd_boolean delay_st_name_p = FALSE;
3121
3122 if (arg->failed)
3123 {
3124 /* We already failed; just get out of the bfd_map_over_sections
3125 loop. */
3126 return;
3127 }
3128
3129 this_hdr = &esd->this_hdr;
3130
3131 if (arg->link_info)
3132 {
3133 /* ld: compress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_*. */
3134 if ((arg->link_info->compress_debug & COMPRESS_DEBUG)
3135 && (asect->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
3136 && name[1] == 'd'
3137 && name[6] == '_')
3138 {
3139 /* Set SEC_ELF_COMPRESS to indicate this section should be
3140 compressed. */
3141 asect->flags |= SEC_ELF_COMPRESS;
3142
3143 /* If this section will be compressed, delay adding section
3144 name to section name section after it is compressed in
3145 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
3146 delay_st_name_p = TRUE;
3147 }
3148 }
3149 else if ((asect->flags & SEC_ELF_RENAME))
3150 {
3151 /* objcopy: rename output DWARF debug section. */
3152 if ((abfd->flags & (BFD_DECOMPRESS | BFD_COMPRESS_GABI)))
3153 {
3154 /* When we decompress or compress with SHF_COMPRESSED,
3155 convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* if
3156 needed. */
3157 if (name[1] == 'z')
3158 {
3159 char *new_name = convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd, name);
3160 if (new_name == NULL)
3161 {
3162 arg->failed = TRUE;
3163 return;
3164 }
3165 name = new_name;
3166 }
3167 }
3168 else if (asect->compress_status == COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE)
3169 {
3170 /* PR binutils/18087: Compression does not always make a
3171 section smaller. So only rename the section when
3172 compression has actually taken place. If input section
3173 name is .zdebug_*, we should never compress it again. */
3174 char *new_name = convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd, name);
3175 if (new_name == NULL)
3176 {
3177 arg->failed = TRUE;
3178 return;
3179 }
3180 BFD_ASSERT (name[1] != 'z');
3181 name = new_name;
3182 }
3183 }
3184
3185 if (delay_st_name_p)
3186 this_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) -1;
3187 else
3188 {
3189 this_hdr->sh_name
3190 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
3191 name, FALSE);
3192 if (this_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3193 {
3194 arg->failed = TRUE;
3195 return;
3196 }
3197 }
3198
3199 /* Don't clear sh_flags. Assembler may set additional bits. */
3200
3201 if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
3202 || asect->user_set_vma)
3203 this_hdr->sh_addr = asect->vma;
3204 else
3205 this_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
3206
3207 this_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
3208 this_hdr->sh_size = asect->size;
3209 this_hdr->sh_link = 0;
3210 /* PR 17512: file: 0eb809fe, 8b0535ee. */
3211 if (asect->alignment_power >= (sizeof (bfd_vma) * 8) - 1)
3212 {
3213 _bfd_error_handler
3214 /* xgettext:c-format */
3215 (_("%B: error: Alignment power %d of section `%A' is too big"),
3216 abfd, asect, asect->alignment_power);
3217 arg->failed = TRUE;
3218 return;
3219 }
3220 this_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << asect->alignment_power;
3221 /* The sh_entsize and sh_info fields may have been set already by
3222 copy_private_section_data. */
3223
3224 this_hdr->bfd_section = asect;
3225 this_hdr->contents = NULL;
3226
3227 /* If the section type is unspecified, we set it based on
3228 asect->flags. */
3229 if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) != 0)
3230 sh_type = SHT_GROUP;
3231 else
3232 sh_type = bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (asect->flags);
3233
3234 if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NULL)
3235 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3236 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
3237 && sh_type == SHT_PROGBITS
3238 && (asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
3239 {
3240 /* Warn if we are changing a NOBITS section to PROGBITS, but
3241 allow the link to proceed. This can happen when users link
3242 non-bss input sections to bss output sections, or emit data
3243 to a bss output section via a linker script. */
3244 _bfd_error_handler
3245 (_("warning: section `%A' type changed to PROGBITS"), asect);
3246 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3247 }
3248
3249 switch (this_hdr->sh_type)
3250 {
3251 default:
3252 break;
3253
3254 case SHT_STRTAB:
3255 case SHT_NOTE:
3256 case SHT_NOBITS:
3257 case SHT_PROGBITS:
3258 break;
3259
3260 case SHT_INIT_ARRAY:
3261 case SHT_FINI_ARRAY:
3262 case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY:
3263 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size / 8;
3264 break;
3265
3266 case SHT_HASH:
3267 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_hash_entry;
3268 break;
3269
3270 case SHT_DYNSYM:
3271 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
3272 break;
3273
3274 case SHT_DYNAMIC:
3275 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_dyn;
3276 break;
3277
3278 case SHT_RELA:
3279 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rela_p)
3280 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rela;
3281 break;
3282
3283 case SHT_REL:
3284 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rel_p)
3285 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rel;
3286 break;
3287
3288 case SHT_GNU_versym:
3289 this_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Versym);
3290 break;
3291
3292 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
3293 this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3294 /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
3295 cverdefs. The linker will set cverdefs, but sh_info will be
3296 zero. */
3297 if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
3298 this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs;
3299 else
3300 BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs == 0
3301 || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs);
3302 break;
3303
3304 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
3305 this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3306 /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
3307 cverrefs. The linker will set cverrefs, but sh_info will be
3308 zero. */
3309 if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
3310 this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs;
3311 else
3312 BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs == 0
3313 || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs);
3314 break;
3315
3316 case SHT_GROUP:
3317 this_hdr->sh_entsize = GRP_ENTRY_SIZE;
3318 break;
3319
3320 case SHT_GNU_HASH:
3321 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size == 64 ? 0 : 4;
3322 break;
3323 }
3324
3325 if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
3326 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
3327 if ((asect->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
3328 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_WRITE;
3329 if ((asect->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
3330 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXECINSTR;
3331 if ((asect->flags & SEC_MERGE) != 0)
3332 {
3333 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MERGE;
3334 this_hdr->sh_entsize = asect->entsize;
3335 }
3336 if ((asect->flags & SEC_STRINGS) != 0)
3337 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_STRINGS;
3338 if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) == 0 && elf_group_name (asect) != NULL)
3339 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3340 if ((asect->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
3341 {
3342 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_TLS;
3343 if (asect->size == 0
3344 && (asect->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
3345 {
3346 struct bfd_link_order *o = asect->map_tail.link_order;
3347
3348 this_hdr->sh_size = 0;
3349 if (o != NULL)
3350 {
3351 this_hdr->sh_size = o->offset + o->size;
3352 if (this_hdr->sh_size != 0)
3353 this_hdr->sh_type = SHT_NOBITS;
3354 }
3355 }
3356 }
3357 if ((asect->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_EXCLUDE)) == SEC_EXCLUDE)
3358 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXCLUDE;
3359
3360 /* If the section has relocs, set up a section header for the
3361 SHT_REL[A] section. If two relocation sections are required for
3362 this section, it is up to the processor-specific back-end to
3363 create the other. */
3364 if ((asect->flags & SEC_RELOC) != 0)
3365 {
3366 /* When doing a relocatable link, create both REL and RELA sections if
3367 needed. */
3368 if (arg->link_info
3369 /* Do the normal setup if we wouldn't create any sections here. */
3370 && esd->rel.count + esd->rela.count > 0
3371 && (bfd_link_relocatable (arg->link_info)
3372 || arg->link_info->emitrelocations))
3373 {
3374 if (esd->rel.count && esd->rel.hdr == NULL
3375 && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rel, name, FALSE,
3376 delay_st_name_p))
3377 {
3378 arg->failed = TRUE;
3379 return;
3380 }
3381 if (esd->rela.count && esd->rela.hdr == NULL
3382 && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rela, name, TRUE,
3383 delay_st_name_p))
3384 {
3385 arg->failed = TRUE;
3386 return;
3387 }
3388 }
3389 else if (!_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd,
3390 (asect->use_rela_p
3391 ? &esd->rela : &esd->rel),
3392 name,
3393 asect->use_rela_p,
3394 delay_st_name_p))
3395 arg->failed = TRUE;
3396 }
3397
3398 /* Check for processor-specific section types. */
3399 sh_type = this_hdr->sh_type;
3400 if (bed->elf_backend_fake_sections
3401 && !(*bed->elf_backend_fake_sections) (abfd, this_hdr, asect))
3402 arg->failed = TRUE;
3403
3404 if (sh_type == SHT_NOBITS && asect->size != 0)
3405 {
3406 /* Don't change the header type from NOBITS if we are being
3407 called for objcopy --only-keep-debug. */
3408 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3409 }
3410 }
3411
3412 /* Fill in the contents of a SHT_GROUP section. Called from
3413 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions for gas, objcopy, and
3414 when ELF targets use the generic linker, ld. Called for ld -r
3415 from bfd_elf_final_link. */
3416
3417 void
3418 bfd_elf_set_group_contents (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, void *failedptrarg)
3419 {
3420 bfd_boolean *failedptr = (bfd_boolean *) failedptrarg;
3421 asection *elt, *first;
3422 unsigned char *loc;
3423 bfd_boolean gas;
3424
3425 /* Ignore linker created group section. See elfNN_ia64_object_p in
3426 elfxx-ia64.c. */
3427 if (((sec->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_LINKER_CREATED)) != SEC_GROUP)
3428 || *failedptr)
3429 return;
3430
3431 if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == 0)
3432 {
3433 unsigned long symindx = 0;
3434
3435 /* elf_group_id will have been set up by objcopy and the
3436 generic linker. */
3437 if (elf_group_id (sec) != NULL)
3438 symindx = elf_group_id (sec)->udata.i;
3439
3440 if (symindx == 0)
3441 {
3442 /* If called from the assembler, swap_out_syms will have set up
3443 elf_section_syms. */
3444 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_syms (abfd) != NULL);
3445 symindx = elf_section_syms (abfd)[sec->index]->udata.i;
3446 }
3447 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = symindx;
3448 }
3449 else if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == (unsigned int) -2)
3450 {
3451 /* The ELF backend linker sets sh_info to -2 when the group
3452 signature symbol is global, and thus the index can't be
3453 set until all local symbols are output. */
3454 asection *igroup;
3455 struct bfd_elf_section_data *sec_data;
3456 unsigned long symndx;
3457 unsigned long extsymoff;
3458 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3459
3460 /* The point of this little dance to the first SHF_GROUP section
3461 then back to the SHT_GROUP section is that this gets us to
3462 the SHT_GROUP in the input object. */
3463 igroup = elf_sec_group (elf_next_in_group (sec));
3464 sec_data = elf_section_data (igroup);
3465 symndx = sec_data->this_hdr.sh_info;
3466 extsymoff = 0;
3467 if (!elf_bad_symtab (igroup->owner))
3468 {
3469 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
3470
3471 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (igroup->owner)->symtab_hdr;
3472 extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
3473 }
3474 h = elf_sym_hashes (igroup->owner)[symndx - extsymoff];
3475 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3476 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3477 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
3478
3479 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = h->indx;
3480 }
3481
3482 /* The contents won't be allocated for "ld -r" or objcopy. */
3483 gas = TRUE;
3484 if (sec->contents == NULL)
3485 {
3486 gas = FALSE;
3487 sec->contents = (unsigned char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sec->size);
3488
3489 /* Arrange for the section to be written out. */
3490 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = sec->contents;
3491 if (sec->contents == NULL)
3492 {
3493 *failedptr = TRUE;
3494 return;
3495 }
3496 }
3497
3498 loc = sec->contents + sec->size;
3499
3500 /* Get the pointer to the first section in the group that gas
3501 squirreled away here. objcopy arranges for this to be set to the
3502 start of the input section group. */
3503 first = elt = elf_next_in_group (sec);
3504
3505 /* First element is a flag word. Rest of section is elf section
3506 indices for all the sections of the group. Write them backwards
3507 just to keep the group in the same order as given in .section
3508 directives, not that it matters. */
3509 while (elt != NULL)
3510 {
3511 asection *s;
3512
3513 s = elt;
3514 if (!gas)
3515 s = s->output_section;
3516 if (s != NULL
3517 && !bfd_is_abs_section (s))
3518 {
3519 unsigned int idx = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3520
3521 loc -= 4;
3522 H_PUT_32 (abfd, idx, loc);
3523 }
3524 elt = elf_next_in_group (elt);
3525 if (elt == first)
3526 break;
3527 }
3528
3529 if ((loc -= 4) != sec->contents)
3530 abort ();
3531
3532 H_PUT_32 (abfd, sec->flags & SEC_LINK_ONCE ? GRP_COMDAT : 0, loc);
3533 }
3534
3535 /* Return the section which RELOC_SEC applies to. */
3536
3537 asection *
3538 _bfd_elf_get_reloc_section (asection *reloc_sec)
3539 {
3540 const char *name;
3541 unsigned int type;
3542 bfd *abfd;
3543
3544 if (reloc_sec == NULL)
3545 return NULL;
3546
3547 type = elf_section_data (reloc_sec)->this_hdr.sh_type;
3548 if (type != SHT_REL && type != SHT_RELA)
3549 return NULL;
3550
3551 /* We look up the section the relocs apply to by name. */
3552 name = reloc_sec->name;
3553 if (type == SHT_REL)
3554 name += 4;
3555 else
3556 name += 5;
3557
3558 /* If a target needs .got.plt section, relocations in rela.plt/rel.plt
3559 section apply to .got.plt section. */
3560 abfd = reloc_sec->owner;
3561 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->want_got_plt
3562 && strcmp (name, ".plt") == 0)
3563 {
3564 /* .got.plt is a linker created input section. It may be mapped
3565 to some other output section. Try two likely sections. */
3566 name = ".got.plt";
3567 reloc_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
3568 if (reloc_sec != NULL)
3569 return reloc_sec;
3570 name = ".got";
3571 }
3572
3573 reloc_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
3574 return reloc_sec;
3575 }
3576
3577 /* Assign all ELF section numbers. The dummy first section is handled here
3578 too. The link/info pointers for the standard section types are filled
3579 in here too, while we're at it. */
3580
3581 static bfd_boolean
3582 assign_section_numbers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
3583 {
3584 struct elf_obj_tdata *t = elf_tdata (abfd);
3585 asection *sec;
3586 unsigned int section_number;
3587 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
3588 struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
3589 bfd_boolean need_symtab;
3590
3591 section_number = 1;
3592
3593 _bfd_elf_strtab_clear_all_refs (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
3594
3595 /* SHT_GROUP sections are in relocatable files only. */
3596 if (link_info == NULL || bfd_link_relocatable (link_info))
3597 {
3598 size_t reloc_count = 0;
3599
3600 /* Put SHT_GROUP sections first. */
3601 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
3602 {
3603 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3604
3605 if (d->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
3606 {
3607 if (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED)
3608 {
3609 /* Remove the linker created SHT_GROUP sections. */
3610 bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, sec);
3611 abfd->section_count--;
3612 }
3613 else
3614 d->this_idx = section_number++;
3615 }
3616
3617 /* Count relocations. */
3618 reloc_count += sec->reloc_count;
3619 }
3620
3621 /* Clear HAS_RELOC if there are no relocations. */
3622 if (reloc_count == 0)
3623 abfd->flags &= ~HAS_RELOC;
3624 }
3625
3626 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
3627 {
3628 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3629
3630 if (d->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_GROUP)
3631 d->this_idx = section_number++;
3632 if (d->this_hdr.sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3633 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->this_hdr.sh_name);
3634 if (d->rel.hdr)
3635 {
3636 d->rel.idx = section_number++;
3637 if (d->rel.hdr->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3638 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rel.hdr->sh_name);
3639 }
3640 else
3641 d->rel.idx = 0;
3642
3643 if (d->rela.hdr)
3644 {
3645 d->rela.idx = section_number++;
3646 if (d->rela.hdr->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3647 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rela.hdr->sh_name);
3648 }
3649 else
3650 d->rela.idx = 0;
3651 }
3652
3653 need_symtab = (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
3654 || (link_info == NULL
3655 && ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
3656 == HAS_RELOC)));
3657 if (need_symtab)
3658 {
3659 elf_onesymtab (abfd) = section_number++;
3660 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->symtab_hdr.sh_name);
3661 if (section_number > ((SHN_LORESERVE - 2) & 0xFFFF))
3662 {
3663 elf_section_list * entry;
3664
3665 BFD_ASSERT (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) == NULL);
3666
3667 entry = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof * entry);
3668 entry->ndx = section_number++;
3669 elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) = entry;
3670 entry->hdr.sh_name
3671 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
3672 ".symtab_shndx", FALSE);
3673 if (entry->hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3674 return FALSE;
3675 }
3676 elf_strtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
3677 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->strtab_hdr.sh_name);
3678 }
3679
3680 elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
3681 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name);
3682 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
3683
3684 if (section_number >= SHN_LORESERVE)
3685 {
3686 /* xgettext:c-format */
3687 _bfd_error_handler (_("%B: too many sections: %u"),
3688 abfd, section_number);
3689 return FALSE;
3690 }
3691
3692 elf_numsections (abfd) = section_number;
3693 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shnum = section_number;
3694
3695 /* Set up the list of section header pointers, in agreement with the
3696 indices. */
3697 i_shdrp = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, section_number,
3698 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *));
3699 if (i_shdrp == NULL)
3700 return FALSE;
3701
3702 i_shdrp[0] = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
3703 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr));
3704 if (i_shdrp[0] == NULL)
3705 {
3706 bfd_release (abfd, i_shdrp);
3707 return FALSE;
3708 }
3709
3710 elf_elfsections (abfd) = i_shdrp;
3711
3712 i_shdrp[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->shstrtab_hdr;
3713 if (need_symtab)
3714 {
3715 i_shdrp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)] = &t->symtab_hdr;
3716 if (elf_numsections (abfd) > (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xFFFF))
3717 {
3718 elf_section_list * entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd);
3719 BFD_ASSERT (entry != NULL);
3720 i_shdrp[entry->ndx] = & entry->hdr;
3721 entry->hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3722 }
3723 i_shdrp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->strtab_hdr;
3724 t->symtab_hdr.sh_link = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
3725 }
3726
3727 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
3728 {
3729 asection *s;
3730
3731 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3732
3733 i_shdrp[d->this_idx] = &d->this_hdr;
3734 if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3735 i_shdrp[d->rel.idx] = d->rel.hdr;
3736 if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3737 i_shdrp[d->rela.idx] = d->rela.hdr;
3738
3739 /* Fill in the sh_link and sh_info fields while we're at it. */
3740
3741 /* sh_link of a reloc section is the section index of the symbol
3742 table. sh_info is the section index of the section to which
3743 the relocation entries apply. */
3744 if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3745 {
3746 d->rel.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3747 d->rel.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3748 d->rel.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3749 }
3750 if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3751 {
3752 d->rela.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3753 d->rela.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3754 d->rela.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3755 }
3756
3757 /* We need to set up sh_link for SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
3758 if ((d->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
3759 {
3760 s = elf_linked_to_section (sec);
3761 if (s)
3762 {
3763 /* elf_linked_to_section points to the input section. */
3764 if (link_info != NULL)
3765 {
3766 /* Check discarded linkonce section. */
3767 if (discarded_section (s))
3768 {
3769 asection *kept;
3770 _bfd_error_handler
3771 /* xgettext:c-format */
3772 (_("%B: sh_link of section `%A' points to discarded section `%A' of `%B'"),
3773 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section,
3774 s, s->owner);
3775 /* Point to the kept section if it has the same
3776 size as the discarded one. */
3777 kept = _bfd_elf_check_kept_section (s, link_info);
3778 if (kept == NULL)
3779 {
3780 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3781 return FALSE;
3782 }
3783 s = kept;
3784 }
3785
3786 s = s->output_section;
3787 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
3788 }
3789 else
3790 {
3791 /* Handle objcopy. */
3792 if (s->output_section == NULL)
3793 {
3794 _bfd_error_handler
3795 /* xgettext:c-format */
3796 (_("%B: sh_link of section `%A' points to removed section `%A' of `%B'"),
3797 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section, s, s->owner);
3798 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3799 return FALSE;
3800 }
3801 s = s->output_section;
3802 }
3803 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3804 }
3805 else
3806 {
3807 /* PR 290:
3808 The Intel C compiler generates SHT_IA_64_UNWIND with
3809 SHF_LINK_ORDER. But it doesn't set the sh_link or
3810 sh_info fields. Hence we could get the situation
3811 where s is NULL. */
3812 const struct elf_backend_data *bed
3813 = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3814 if (bed->link_order_error_handler)
3815 bed->link_order_error_handler
3816 /* xgettext:c-format */
3817 (_("%B: warning: sh_link not set for section `%A'"),
3818 abfd, sec);
3819 }
3820 }
3821
3822 switch (d->this_hdr.sh_type)
3823 {
3824 case SHT_REL:
3825 case SHT_RELA:
3826 /* A reloc section which we are treating as a normal BFD
3827 section. sh_link is the section index of the symbol
3828 table. sh_info is the section index of the section to
3829 which the relocation entries apply. We assume that an
3830 allocated reloc section uses the dynamic symbol table.
3831 FIXME: How can we be sure? */
3832 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3833 if (s != NULL)
3834 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3835
3836 s = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->get_reloc_section (sec);
3837 if (s != NULL)
3838 {
3839 d->this_hdr.sh_info = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3840 d->this_hdr.sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3841 }
3842 break;
3843
3844 case SHT_STRTAB:
3845 /* We assume that a section named .stab*str is a stabs
3846 string section. We look for a section with the same name
3847 but without the trailing ``str'', and set its sh_link
3848 field to point to this section. */
3849 if (CONST_STRNEQ (sec->name, ".stab")
3850 && strcmp (sec->name + strlen (sec->name) - 3, "str") == 0)
3851 {
3852 size_t len;
3853 char *alc;
3854
3855 len = strlen (sec->name);
3856 alc = (char *) bfd_malloc (len - 2);
3857 if (alc == NULL)
3858 return FALSE;
3859 memcpy (alc, sec->name, len - 3);
3860 alc[len - 3] = '\0';
3861 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, alc);
3862 free (alc);
3863 if (s != NULL)
3864 {
3865 elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link = d->this_idx;
3866
3867 /* This is a .stab section. */
3868 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize == 0)
3869 elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
3870 = 4 + 2 * bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 8;
3871 }
3872 }
3873 break;
3874
3875 case SHT_DYNAMIC:
3876 case SHT_DYNSYM:
3877 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
3878 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
3879 /* sh_link is the section header index of the string table
3880 used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or the
3881 version strings. */
3882 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
3883 if (s != NULL)
3884 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3885 break;
3886
3887 case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST:
3888 /* sh_link is the section header index of the prelink library
3889 list used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or
3890 the version strings. */
3891 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC)
3892 ? ".dynstr" : ".gnu.libstr");
3893 if (s != NULL)
3894 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3895 break;
3896
3897 case SHT_HASH:
3898 case SHT_GNU_HASH:
3899 case SHT_GNU_versym:
3900 /* sh_link is the section header index of the symbol table
3901 this hash table or version table is for. */
3902 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3903 if (s != NULL)
3904 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3905 break;
3906
3907 case SHT_GROUP:
3908 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3909 }
3910 }
3911
3912 /* Delay setting sh_name to _bfd_elf_write_object_contents so that
3913 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load can convert DWARF
3914 debug section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_* if needed. */
3915
3916 return TRUE;
3917 }
3918
3919 static bfd_boolean
3920 sym_is_global (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
3921 {
3922 /* If the backend has a special mapping, use it. */
3923 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3924 if (bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global)
3925 return (*bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global) (abfd, sym);
3926
3927 return ((sym->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK | BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)) != 0
3928 || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_get_section (sym))
3929 || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_get_section (sym)));
3930 }
3931
3932 /* Filter global symbols of ABFD to include in the import library. All
3933 SYMCOUNT symbols of ABFD can be examined from their pointers in
3934 SYMS. Pointers of symbols to keep should be stored contiguously at
3935 the beginning of that array.
3936
3937 Returns the number of symbols to keep. */
3938
3939 unsigned int
3940 _bfd_elf_filter_global_symbols (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3941 asymbol **syms, long symcount)
3942 {
3943 long src_count, dst_count = 0;
3944
3945 for (src_count = 0; src_count < symcount; src_count++)
3946 {
3947 asymbol *sym = syms[src_count];
3948 char *name = (char *) bfd_asymbol_name (sym);
3949 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h;
3950
3951 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
3952 continue;
3953
3954 h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash, name, FALSE, FALSE, FALSE);
3955 if (h == NULL)
3956 continue;
3957 if (h->type != bfd_link_hash_defined && h->type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
3958 continue;
3959 if (h->linker_def || h->ldscript_def)
3960 continue;
3961
3962 syms[dst_count++] = sym;
3963 }
3964
3965 syms[dst_count] = NULL;
3966
3967 return dst_count;
3968 }
3969
3970 /* Don't output section symbols for sections that are not going to be
3971 output, that are duplicates or there is no BFD section. */
3972
3973 static bfd_boolean
3974 ignore_section_sym (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
3975 {
3976 elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
3977
3978 if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0)
3979 return FALSE;
3980
3981 type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, sym);
3982 return ((type_ptr != NULL
3983 && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
3984 && bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
3985 || !(sym->section->owner == abfd
3986 || (sym->section->output_section->owner == abfd
3987 && sym->section->output_offset == 0)
3988 || bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section)));
3989 }
3990
3991 /* Map symbol from it's internal number to the external number, moving
3992 all local symbols to be at the head of the list. */
3993
3994 static bfd_boolean
3995 elf_map_symbols (bfd *abfd, unsigned int *pnum_locals)
3996 {
3997 unsigned int symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
3998 asymbol **syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
3999 asymbol **sect_syms;
4000 unsigned int num_locals = 0;
4001 unsigned int num_globals = 0;
4002 unsigned int num_locals2 = 0;
4003 unsigned int num_globals2 = 0;
4004 unsigned int max_index = 0;
4005 unsigned int idx;
4006 asection *asect;
4007 asymbol **new_syms;
4008
4009 #ifdef DEBUG
4010 fprintf (stderr, "elf_map_symbols\n");
4011 fflush (stderr);
4012 #endif
4013
4014 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4015 {
4016 if (max_index < asect->index)
4017 max_index = asect->index;
4018 }
4019
4020 max_index++;
4021 sect_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, max_index, sizeof (asymbol *));
4022 if (sect_syms == NULL)
4023 return FALSE;
4024 elf_section_syms (abfd) = sect_syms;
4025 elf_num_section_syms (abfd) = max_index;
4026
4027 /* Init sect_syms entries for any section symbols we have already
4028 decided to output. */
4029 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4030 {
4031 asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
4032
4033 if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0
4034 && sym->value == 0
4035 && !ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym)
4036 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
4037 {
4038 asection *sec = sym->section;
4039
4040 if (sec->owner != abfd)
4041 sec = sec->output_section;
4042
4043 sect_syms[sec->index] = syms[idx];
4044 }
4045 }
4046
4047 /* Classify all of the symbols. */
4048 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4049 {
4050 if (sym_is_global (abfd, syms[idx]))
4051 num_globals++;
4052 else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, syms[idx]))
4053 num_locals++;
4054 }
4055
4056 /* We will be adding a section symbol for each normal BFD section. Most
4057 sections will already have a section symbol in outsymbols, but
4058 eg. SHT_GROUP sections will not, and we need the section symbol mapped
4059 at least in that case. */
4060 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4061 {
4062 if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
4063 {
4064 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, asect->symbol))
4065 num_locals++;
4066 else
4067 num_globals++;
4068 }
4069 }
4070
4071 /* Now sort the symbols so the local symbols are first. */
4072 new_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_alloc2 (abfd, num_locals + num_globals,
4073 sizeof (asymbol *));
4074
4075 if (new_syms == NULL)
4076 return FALSE;
4077
4078 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4079 {
4080 asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
4081 unsigned int i;
4082
4083 if (sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
4084 i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
4085 else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym))
4086 i = num_locals2++;
4087 else
4088 continue;
4089 new_syms[i] = sym;
4090 sym->udata.i = i + 1;
4091 }
4092 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4093 {
4094 if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
4095 {
4096 asymbol *sym = asect->symbol;
4097 unsigned int i;
4098
4099 sect_syms[asect->index] = sym;
4100 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
4101 i = num_locals2++;
4102 else
4103 i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
4104 new_syms[i] = sym;
4105 sym->udata.i = i + 1;
4106 }
4107 }
4108
4109 bfd_set_symtab (abfd, new_syms, num_locals + num_globals);
4110
4111 *pnum_locals = num_locals;
4112 return TRUE;
4113 }
4114
4115 /* Align to the maximum file alignment that could be required for any
4116 ELF data structure. */
4117
4118 static inline file_ptr
4119 align_file_position (file_ptr off, int align)
4120 {
4121 return (off + align - 1) & ~(align - 1);
4122 }
4123
4124 /* Assign a file position to a section, optionally aligning to the
4125 required section alignment. */
4126
4127 file_ptr
4128 _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (Elf_Internal_Shdr *i_shdrp,
4129 file_ptr offset,
4130 bfd_boolean align)
4131 {
4132 if (align && i_shdrp->sh_addralign > 1)
4133 offset = BFD_ALIGN (offset, i_shdrp->sh_addralign);
4134 i_shdrp->sh_offset = offset;
4135 if (i_shdrp->bfd_section != NULL)
4136 i_shdrp->bfd_section->filepos = offset;
4137 if (i_shdrp->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
4138 offset += i_shdrp->sh_size;
4139 return offset;
4140 }
4141
4142 /* Compute the file positions we are going to put the sections at, and
4143 otherwise prepare to begin writing out the ELF file. If LINK_INFO
4144 is not NULL, this is being called by the ELF backend linker. */
4145
4146 bfd_boolean
4147 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (bfd *abfd,
4148 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
4149 {
4150 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4151 struct fake_section_arg fsargs;
4152 bfd_boolean failed;
4153 struct elf_strtab_hash *strtab = NULL;
4154 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shstrtab_hdr;
4155 bfd_boolean need_symtab;
4156
4157 if (abfd->output_has_begun)
4158 return TRUE;
4159
4160 /* Do any elf backend specific processing first. */
4161 if (bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing)
4162 (*bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing) (abfd, link_info);
4163
4164 if (! prep_headers (abfd))
4165 return FALSE;
4166
4167 /* Post process the headers if necessary. */
4168 (*bed->elf_backend_post_process_headers) (abfd, link_info);
4169
4170 fsargs.failed = FALSE;
4171 fsargs.link_info = link_info;
4172 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, elf_fake_sections, &fsargs);
4173 if (fsargs.failed)
4174 return FALSE;
4175
4176 if (!assign_section_numbers (abfd, link_info))
4177 return FALSE;
4178
4179 /* The backend linker builds symbol table information itself. */
4180 need_symtab = (link_info == NULL
4181 && (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
4182 || ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
4183 == HAS_RELOC)));
4184 if (need_symtab)
4185 {
4186 /* Non-zero if doing a relocatable link. */
4187 int relocatable_p = ! (abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC));
4188
4189 if (! swap_out_syms (abfd, &strtab, relocatable_p))
4190 return FALSE;
4191 }
4192
4193 failed = FALSE;
4194 if (link_info == NULL)
4195 {
4196 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bfd_elf_set_group_contents, &failed);
4197 if (failed)
4198 return FALSE;
4199 }
4200
4201 shstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
4202 /* sh_name was set in prep_headers. */
4203 shstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
4204 shstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = bed->elf_strtab_flags;
4205 shstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
4206 /* sh_size is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
4207 shstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
4208 shstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
4209 shstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
4210 /* sh_offset is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
4211 shstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
4212
4213 if (!assign_file_positions_except_relocs (abfd, link_info))
4214 return FALSE;
4215
4216 if (need_symtab)
4217 {
4218 file_ptr off;
4219 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
4220
4221 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
4222
4223 hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
4224 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4225
4226 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL)
4227 {
4228 hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->hdr;
4229 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
4230 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4231 /* FIXME: What about other symtab_shndx sections in the list ? */
4232 }
4233
4234 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
4235 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4236
4237 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
4238
4239 /* Now that we know where the .strtab section goes, write it
4240 out. */
4241 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
4242 || ! _bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, strtab))
4243 return FALSE;
4244 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (strtab);
4245 }
4246
4247 abfd->output_has_begun = TRUE;
4248
4249 return TRUE;
4250 }
4251
4252 /* Make an initial estimate of the size of the program header. If we
4253 get the number wrong here, we'll redo section placement. */
4254
4255 static bfd_size_type
4256 get_program_header_size (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4257 {
4258 size_t segs;
4259 asection *s;
4260 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
4261
4262 /* Assume we will need exactly two PT_LOAD segments: one for text
4263 and one for data. */
4264 segs = 2;
4265
4266 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
4267 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
4268 {
4269 /* If we have a loadable interpreter section, we need a
4270 PT_INTERP segment. In this case, assume we also need a
4271 PT_PHDR segment, although that may not be true for all
4272 targets. */
4273 segs += 2;
4274 }
4275
4276 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL)
4277 {
4278 /* We need a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4279 ++segs;
4280 }
4281
4282 if (info != NULL && info->relro)
4283 {
4284 /* We need a PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
4285 ++segs;
4286 }
4287
4288 if (elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd))
4289 {
4290 /* We need a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME segment. */
4291 ++segs;
4292 }
4293
4294 if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
4295 {
4296 /* We need a PT_GNU_STACK segment. */
4297 ++segs;
4298 }
4299
4300 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4301 {
4302 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4303 && CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".note"))
4304 {
4305 /* We need a PT_NOTE segment. */
4306 ++segs;
4307 /* Try to create just one PT_NOTE segment
4308 for all adjacent loadable .note* sections.
4309 gABI requires that within a PT_NOTE segment
4310 (and also inside of each SHT_NOTE section)
4311 each note is padded to a multiple of 4 size,
4312 so we check whether the sections are correctly
4313 aligned. */
4314 if (s->alignment_power == 2)
4315 while (s->next != NULL
4316 && s->next->alignment_power == 2
4317 && (s->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4318 && CONST_STRNEQ (s->next->name, ".note"))
4319 s = s->next;
4320 }
4321 }
4322
4323 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4324 {
4325 if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4326 {
4327 /* We need a PT_TLS segment. */
4328 ++segs;
4329 break;
4330 }
4331 }
4332
4333 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4334
4335 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
4336 {
4337 /* Add a PT_GNU_MBIND segment for each mbind section. */
4338 unsigned int page_align_power = bfd_log2 (bed->commonpagesize);
4339 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4340 if (elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND)
4341 {
4342 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info
4343 > PT_GNU_MBIND_NUM)
4344 {
4345 _bfd_error_handler
4346 /* xgettext:c-format */
4347 (_("%B: GNU_MBIN section `%A' has invalid sh_info field: %d"),
4348 abfd, s, elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info);
4349 continue;
4350 }
4351 /* Align mbind section to page size. */
4352 if (s->alignment_power < page_align_power)
4353 s->alignment_power = page_align_power;
4354 segs ++;
4355 }
4356 }
4357
4358 /* Let the backend count up any program headers it might need. */
4359 if (bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers)
4360 {
4361 int a;
4362
4363 a = (*bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers) (abfd, info);
4364 if (a == -1)
4365 abort ();
4366 segs += a;
4367 }
4368
4369 return segs * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4370 }
4371
4372 /* Find the segment that contains the output_section of section. */
4373
4374 Elf_Internal_Phdr *
4375 _bfd_elf_find_segment_containing_section (bfd * abfd, asection * section)
4376 {
4377 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4378 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
4379
4380 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
4381 m != NULL;
4382 m = m->next, p++)
4383 {
4384 int i;
4385
4386 for (i = m->count - 1; i >= 0; i--)
4387 if (m->sections[i] == section)
4388 return p;
4389 }
4390
4391 return NULL;
4392 }
4393
4394 /* Create a mapping from a set of sections to a program segment. */
4395
4396 static struct elf_segment_map *
4397 make_mapping (bfd *abfd,
4398 asection **sections,
4399 unsigned int from,
4400 unsigned int to,
4401 bfd_boolean phdr)
4402 {
4403 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4404 unsigned int i;
4405 asection **hdrpp;
4406 bfd_size_type amt;
4407
4408 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4409 amt += (to - from - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4410 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4411 if (m == NULL)
4412 return NULL;
4413 m->next = NULL;
4414 m->p_type = PT_LOAD;
4415 for (i = from, hdrpp = sections + from; i < to; i++, hdrpp++)
4416 m->sections[i - from] = *hdrpp;
4417 m->count = to - from;
4418
4419 if (from == 0 && phdr)
4420 {
4421 /* Include the headers in the first PT_LOAD segment. */
4422 m->includes_filehdr = 1;
4423 m->includes_phdrs = 1;
4424 }
4425
4426 return m;
4427 }
4428
4429 /* Create the PT_DYNAMIC segment, which includes DYNSEC. Returns NULL
4430 on failure. */
4431
4432 struct elf_segment_map *
4433 _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (bfd *abfd, asection *dynsec)
4434 {
4435 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4436
4437 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
4438 sizeof (struct elf_segment_map));
4439 if (m == NULL)
4440 return NULL;
4441 m->next = NULL;
4442 m->p_type = PT_DYNAMIC;
4443 m->count = 1;
4444 m->sections[0] = dynsec;
4445
4446 return m;
4447 }
4448
4449 /* Possibly add or remove segments from the segment map. */
4450
4451 static bfd_boolean
4452 elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
4453 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4454 bfd_boolean remove_empty_load)
4455 {
4456 struct elf_segment_map **m;
4457 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
4458
4459 /* The placement algorithm assumes that non allocated sections are
4460 not in PT_LOAD segments. We ensure this here by removing such
4461 sections from the segment map. We also remove excluded
4462 sections. Finally, any PT_LOAD segment without sections is
4463 removed. */
4464 m = &elf_seg_map (abfd);
4465 while (*m)
4466 {
4467 unsigned int i, new_count;
4468
4469 for (new_count = 0, i = 0; i < (*m)->count; i++)
4470 {
4471 if (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0
4472 && (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
4473 || (*m)->p_type != PT_LOAD))
4474 {
4475 (*m)->sections[new_count] = (*m)->sections[i];
4476 new_count++;
4477 }
4478 }
4479 (*m)->count = new_count;
4480
4481 if (remove_empty_load
4482 && (*m)->p_type == PT_LOAD
4483 && (*m)->count == 0
4484 && !(*m)->includes_phdrs)
4485 *m = (*m)->next;
4486 else
4487 m = &(*m)->next;
4488 }
4489
4490 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4491 if (bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map != NULL)
4492 {
4493 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map) (abfd, info))
4494 return FALSE;
4495 }
4496
4497 return TRUE;
4498 }
4499
4500 /* Set up a mapping from BFD sections to program segments. */
4501
4502 bfd_boolean
4503 _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4504 {
4505 unsigned int count;
4506 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4507 asection **sections = NULL;
4508 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4509 bfd_boolean no_user_phdrs;
4510
4511 no_user_phdrs = elf_seg_map (abfd) == NULL;
4512
4513 if (info != NULL)
4514 info->user_phdrs = !no_user_phdrs;
4515
4516 if (no_user_phdrs && bfd_count_sections (abfd) != 0)
4517 {
4518 asection *s;
4519 unsigned int i;
4520 struct elf_segment_map *mfirst;
4521 struct elf_segment_map **pm;
4522 asection *last_hdr;
4523 bfd_vma last_size;
4524 unsigned int phdr_index;
4525 bfd_vma maxpagesize;
4526 asection **hdrpp;
4527 bfd_boolean phdr_in_segment = TRUE;
4528 bfd_boolean writable;
4529 int tls_count = 0;
4530 asection *first_tls = NULL;
4531 asection *first_mbind = NULL;
4532 asection *dynsec, *eh_frame_hdr;
4533 bfd_size_type amt;
4534 bfd_vma addr_mask, wrap_to = 0;
4535 bfd_boolean linker_created_pt_phdr_segment = FALSE;
4536
4537 /* Select the allocated sections, and sort them. */
4538
4539 sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc2 (bfd_count_sections (abfd),
4540 sizeof (asection *));
4541 if (sections == NULL)
4542 goto error_return;
4543
4544 /* Calculate top address, avoiding undefined behaviour of shift
4545 left operator when shift count is equal to size of type
4546 being shifted. */
4547 addr_mask = ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bfd_arch_bits_per_address (abfd) - 1)) - 1;
4548 addr_mask = (addr_mask << 1) + 1;
4549
4550 i = 0;
4551 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4552 {
4553 if ((s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
4554 {
4555 sections[i] = s;
4556 ++i;
4557 /* A wrapping section potentially clashes with header. */
4558 if (((s->lma + s->size) & addr_mask) < (s->lma & addr_mask))
4559 wrap_to = (s->lma + s->size) & addr_mask;
4560 }
4561 }
4562 BFD_ASSERT (i <= bfd_count_sections (abfd));
4563 count = i;
4564
4565 qsort (sections, (size_t) count, sizeof (asection *), elf_sort_sections);
4566
4567 /* Build the mapping. */
4568
4569 mfirst = NULL;
4570 pm = &mfirst;
4571
4572 /* If we have a .interp section, then create a PT_PHDR segment for
4573 the program headers and a PT_INTERP segment for the .interp
4574 section. */
4575 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
4576 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
4577 {
4578 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4579 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4580 if (m == NULL)
4581 goto error_return;
4582 m->next = NULL;
4583 m->p_type = PT_PHDR;
4584 /* FIXME: UnixWare and Solaris set PF_X, Irix 5 does not. */
4585 m->p_flags = PF_R | PF_X;
4586 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4587 m->includes_phdrs = 1;
4588 linker_created_pt_phdr_segment = TRUE;
4589 *pm = m;
4590 pm = &m->next;
4591
4592 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4593 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4594 if (m == NULL)
4595 goto error_return;
4596 m->next = NULL;
4597 m->p_type = PT_INTERP;
4598 m->count = 1;
4599 m->sections[0] = s;
4600
4601 *pm = m;
4602 pm = &m->next;
4603 }
4604
4605 /* Look through the sections. We put sections in the same program
4606 segment when the start of the second section can be placed within
4607 a few bytes of the end of the first section. */
4608 last_hdr = NULL;
4609 last_size = 0;
4610 phdr_index = 0;
4611 maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
4612 /* PR 17512: file: c8455299.
4613 Avoid divide-by-zero errors later on.
4614 FIXME: Should we abort if the maxpagesize is zero ? */
4615 if (maxpagesize == 0)
4616 maxpagesize = 1;
4617 writable = FALSE;
4618 dynsec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
4619 if (dynsec != NULL
4620 && (dynsec->flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
4621 dynsec = NULL;
4622
4623 /* Deal with -Ttext or something similar such that the first section
4624 is not adjacent to the program headers. This is an
4625 approximation, since at this point we don't know exactly how many
4626 program headers we will need. */
4627 if (count > 0)
4628 {
4629 bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
4630
4631 if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
4632 phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
4633 phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4634 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0
4635 || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) < phdr_size
4636 || ((sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) % maxpagesize
4637 < phdr_size % maxpagesize)
4638 || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask & -maxpagesize) < wrap_to)
4639 {
4640 /* PR 20815: The ELF standard says that a PT_PHDR segment, if
4641 present, must be included as part of the memory image of the
4642 program. Ie it must be part of a PT_LOAD segment as well.
4643 If we have had to create our own PT_PHDR segment, but it is
4644 not going to be covered by the first PT_LOAD segment, then
4645 force the inclusion if we can... */
4646 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
4647 && linker_created_pt_phdr_segment)
4648 phdr_in_segment = TRUE;
4649 else
4650 phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
4651 }
4652 }
4653
4654 for (i = 0, hdrpp = sections; i < count; i++, hdrpp++)
4655 {
4656 asection *hdr;
4657 bfd_boolean new_segment;
4658
4659 hdr = *hdrpp;
4660
4661 /* See if this section and the last one will fit in the same
4662 segment. */
4663
4664 if (last_hdr == NULL)
4665 {
4666 /* If we don't have a segment yet, then we don't need a new
4667 one (we build the last one after this loop). */
4668 new_segment = FALSE;
4669 }
4670 else if (last_hdr->lma - last_hdr->vma != hdr->lma - hdr->vma)
4671 {
4672 /* If this section has a different relation between the
4673 virtual address and the load address, then we need a new
4674 segment. */
4675 new_segment = TRUE;
4676 }
4677 else if (hdr->lma < last_hdr->lma + last_size
4678 || last_hdr->lma + last_size < last_hdr->lma)
4679 {
4680 /* If this section has a load address that makes it overlap
4681 the previous section, then we need a new segment. */
4682 new_segment = TRUE;
4683 }
4684 /* In the next test we have to be careful when last_hdr->lma is close
4685 to the end of the address space. If the aligned address wraps
4686 around to the start of the address space, then there are no more
4687 pages left in memory and it is OK to assume that the current
4688 section can be included in the current segment. */
4689 else if ((BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize) + maxpagesize
4690 > last_hdr->lma)
4691 && (BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize) + maxpagesize
4692 <= hdr->lma))
4693 {
4694 /* If putting this section in this segment would force us to
4695 skip a page in the segment, then we need a new segment. */
4696 new_segment = TRUE;
4697 }
4698 else if ((last_hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0
4699 && (hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) != 0
4700 && ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0
4701 || (((last_hdr->lma + last_size - 1) & -maxpagesize)
4702 != (hdr->lma & -maxpagesize))))
4703 {
4704 /* We don't want to put a loaded section after a
4705 nonloaded (ie. bss style) section in the same segment
4706 as that will force the non-loaded section to be loaded.
4707 Consider .tbss sections as loaded for this purpose.
4708 However, like the writable/non-writable case below,
4709 if they are on the same page then they must be put
4710 in the same segment. */
4711 new_segment = TRUE;
4712 }
4713 else if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0)
4714 {
4715 /* If the file is not demand paged, which means that we
4716 don't require the sections to be correctly aligned in the
4717 file, then there is no other reason for a new segment. */
4718 new_segment = FALSE;
4719 }
4720 else if (! writable
4721 && (hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0
4722 && (((last_hdr->lma + last_size - 1) & -maxpagesize)
4723 != (hdr->lma & -maxpagesize)))
4724 {
4725 /* We don't want to put a writable section in a read only
4726 segment, unless they are on the same page in memory
4727 anyhow. We already know that the last section does not
4728 bring us past the current section on the page, so the
4729 only case in which the new section is not on the same
4730 page as the previous section is when the previous section
4731 ends precisely on a page boundary. */
4732 new_segment = TRUE;
4733 }
4734 else
4735 {
4736 /* Otherwise, we can use the same segment. */
4737 new_segment = FALSE;
4738 }
4739
4740 /* Allow interested parties a chance to override our decision. */
4741 if (last_hdr != NULL
4742 && info != NULL
4743 && info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment != NULL)
4744 new_segment
4745 = info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment (info, abfd, hdr,
4746 last_hdr,
4747 new_segment);
4748
4749 if (! new_segment)
4750 {
4751 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4752 writable = TRUE;
4753 last_hdr = hdr;
4754 /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4755 if ((hdr->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD))
4756 != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4757 last_size = hdr->size;
4758 else
4759 last_size = 0;
4760 continue;
4761 }
4762
4763 /* We need a new program segment. We must create a new program
4764 header holding all the sections from phdr_index until hdr. */
4765
4766 m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, phdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
4767 if (m == NULL)
4768 goto error_return;
4769
4770 *pm = m;
4771 pm = &m->next;
4772
4773 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4774 writable = TRUE;
4775 else
4776 writable = FALSE;
4777
4778 last_hdr = hdr;
4779 /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4780 if ((hdr->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD)) != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4781 last_size = hdr->size;
4782 else
4783 last_size = 0;
4784 phdr_index = i;
4785 phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
4786 }
4787
4788 /* Create a final PT_LOAD program segment, but not if it's just
4789 for .tbss. */
4790 if (last_hdr != NULL
4791 && (i - phdr_index != 1
4792 || ((last_hdr->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD))
4793 != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)))
4794 {
4795 m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, phdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
4796 if (m == NULL)
4797 goto error_return;
4798
4799 *pm = m;
4800 pm = &m->next;
4801 }
4802
4803 /* If there is a .dynamic section, throw in a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4804 if (dynsec != NULL)
4805 {
4806 m = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (abfd, dynsec);
4807 if (m == NULL)
4808 goto error_return;
4809 *pm = m;
4810 pm = &m->next;
4811 }
4812
4813 /* For each batch of consecutive loadable .note sections,
4814 add a PT_NOTE segment. We don't use bfd_get_section_by_name,
4815 because if we link together nonloadable .note sections and
4816 loadable .note sections, we will generate two .note sections
4817 in the output file. FIXME: Using names for section types is
4818 bogus anyhow. */
4819 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4820 {
4821 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4822 && CONST_STRNEQ (s->name, ".note"))
4823 {
4824 asection *s2;
4825
4826 count = 1;
4827 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4828 if (s->alignment_power == 2)
4829 for (s2 = s; s2->next != NULL; s2 = s2->next)
4830 {
4831 if (s2->next->alignment_power == 2
4832 && (s2->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4833 && CONST_STRNEQ (s2->next->name, ".note")
4834 && align_power (s2->lma + s2->size, 2)
4835 == s2->next->lma)
4836 count++;
4837 else
4838 break;
4839 }
4840 amt += (count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4841 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4842 if (m == NULL)
4843 goto error_return;
4844 m->next = NULL;
4845 m->p_type = PT_NOTE;
4846 m->count = count;
4847 while (count > 1)
4848 {
4849 m->sections[m->count - count--] = s;
4850 BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
4851 s = s->next;
4852 }
4853 m->sections[m->count - 1] = s;
4854 BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
4855 *pm = m;
4856 pm = &m->next;
4857 }
4858 if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4859 {
4860 if (! tls_count)
4861 first_tls = s;
4862 tls_count++;
4863 }
4864 if (first_mbind == NULL
4865 && (elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND) != 0)
4866 first_mbind = s;
4867 }
4868
4869 /* If there are any SHF_TLS output sections, add PT_TLS segment. */
4870 if (tls_count > 0)
4871 {
4872 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4873 amt += (tls_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
4874 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4875 if (m == NULL)
4876 goto error_return;
4877 m->next = NULL;
4878 m->p_type = PT_TLS;
4879 m->count = tls_count;
4880 /* Mandated PF_R. */
4881 m->p_flags = PF_R;
4882 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4883 s = first_tls;
4884 for (i = 0; i < (unsigned int) tls_count; ++i)
4885 {
4886 if ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0)
4887 {
4888 _bfd_error_handler
4889 (_("%B: TLS sections are not adjacent:"), abfd);
4890 s = first_tls;
4891 i = 0;
4892 while (i < (unsigned int) tls_count)
4893 {
4894 if ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
4895 {
4896 _bfd_error_handler (_(" TLS: %A"), s);
4897 i++;
4898 }
4899 else
4900 _bfd_error_handler (_(" non-TLS: %A"), s);
4901 s = s->next;
4902 }
4903 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
4904 goto error_return;
4905 }
4906 m->sections[i] = s;
4907 s = s->next;
4908 }
4909
4910 *pm = m;
4911 pm = &m->next;
4912 }
4913
4914 if (first_mbind && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
4915 for (s = first_mbind; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4916 if ((elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND) != 0
4917 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info
4918 <= PT_GNU_MBIND_NUM))
4919 {
4920 /* Mandated PF_R. */
4921 unsigned long p_flags = PF_R;
4922 if ((s->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4923 p_flags |= PF_W;
4924 if ((s->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
4925 p_flags |= PF_X;
4926
4927 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) + sizeof (asection *);
4928 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4929 if (m == NULL)
4930 goto error_return;
4931 m->next = NULL;
4932 m->p_type = (PT_GNU_MBIND_LO
4933 + elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info);
4934 m->count = 1;
4935 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4936 m->sections[0] = s;
4937 m->p_flags = p_flags;
4938
4939 *pm = m;
4940 pm = &m->next;
4941 }
4942
4943 /* If there is a .eh_frame_hdr section, throw in a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME
4944 segment. */
4945 eh_frame_hdr = elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd);
4946 if (eh_frame_hdr != NULL
4947 && (eh_frame_hdr->output_section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
4948 {
4949 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4950 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4951 if (m == NULL)
4952 goto error_return;
4953 m->next = NULL;
4954 m->p_type = PT_GNU_EH_FRAME;
4955 m->count = 1;
4956 m->sections[0] = eh_frame_hdr->output_section;
4957
4958 *pm = m;
4959 pm = &m->next;
4960 }
4961
4962 if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
4963 {
4964 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4965 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4966 if (m == NULL)
4967 goto error_return;
4968 m->next = NULL;
4969 m->p_type = PT_GNU_STACK;
4970 m->p_flags = elf_stack_flags (abfd);
4971 m->p_align = bed->stack_align;
4972 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4973 m->p_align_valid = m->p_align != 0;
4974 if (info->stacksize > 0)
4975 {
4976 m->p_size = info->stacksize;
4977 m->p_size_valid = 1;
4978 }
4979
4980 *pm = m;
4981 pm = &m->next;
4982 }
4983
4984 if (info != NULL && info->relro)
4985 {
4986 for (m = mfirst; m != NULL; m = m->next)
4987 {
4988 if (m->p_type == PT_LOAD
4989 && m->count != 0
4990 && m->sections[0]->vma >= info->relro_start
4991 && m->sections[0]->vma < info->relro_end)
4992 {
4993 i = m->count;
4994 while (--i != (unsigned) -1)
4995 if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
4996 == (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
4997 break;
4998
4999 if (i != (unsigned) -1)
5000 break;
5001 }
5002 }
5003
5004 /* Make a PT_GNU_RELRO segment only when it isn't empty. */
5005 if (m != NULL)
5006 {
5007 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5008 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5009 if (m == NULL)
5010 goto error_return;
5011 m->next = NULL;
5012 m->p_type = PT_GNU_RELRO;
5013 *pm = m;
5014 pm = &m->next;
5015 }
5016 }
5017
5018 free (sections);
5019 elf_seg_map (abfd) = mfirst;
5020 }
5021
5022 if (!elf_modify_segment_map (abfd, info, no_user_phdrs))
5023 return FALSE;
5024
5025 for (count = 0, m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5026 ++count;
5027 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = count * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5028
5029 return TRUE;
5030
5031 error_return:
5032 if (sections != NULL)
5033 free (sections);
5034 return FALSE;
5035 }
5036
5037 /* Sort sections by address. */
5038
5039 static int
5040 elf_sort_sections (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
5041 {
5042 const asection *sec1 = *(const asection **) arg1;
5043 const asection *sec2 = *(const asection **) arg2;
5044 bfd_size_type size1, size2;
5045
5046 /* Sort by LMA first, since this is the address used to
5047 place the section into a segment. */
5048 if (sec1->lma < sec2->lma)
5049 return -1;
5050 else if (sec1->lma > sec2->lma)
5051 return 1;
5052
5053 /* Then sort by VMA. Normally the LMA and the VMA will be
5054 the same, and this will do nothing. */
5055 if (sec1->vma < sec2->vma)
5056 return -1;
5057 else if (sec1->vma > sec2->vma)
5058 return 1;
5059
5060 /* Put !SEC_LOAD sections after SEC_LOAD ones. */
5061
5062 #define TOEND(x) (((x)->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0)
5063
5064 if (TOEND (sec1))
5065 {
5066 if (TOEND (sec2))
5067 {
5068 /* If the indicies are the same, do not return 0
5069 here, but continue to try the next comparison. */
5070 if (sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index != 0)
5071 return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
5072 }
5073 else
5074 return 1;
5075 }
5076 else if (TOEND (sec2))
5077 return -1;
5078
5079 #undef TOEND
5080
5081 /* Sort by size, to put zero sized sections
5082 before others at the same address. */
5083
5084 size1 = (sec1->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec1->size : 0;
5085 size2 = (sec2->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec2->size : 0;
5086
5087 if (size1 < size2)
5088 return -1;
5089 if (size1 > size2)
5090 return 1;
5091
5092 return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
5093 }
5094
5095 /* Ian Lance Taylor writes:
5096
5097 We shouldn't be using % with a negative signed number. That's just
5098 not good. We have to make sure either that the number is not
5099 negative, or that the number has an unsigned type. When the types
5100 are all the same size they wind up as unsigned. When file_ptr is a
5101 larger signed type, the arithmetic winds up as signed long long,
5102 which is wrong.
5103
5104 What we're trying to say here is something like ``increase OFF by
5105 the least amount that will cause it to be equal to the VMA modulo
5106 the page size.'' */
5107 /* In other words, something like:
5108
5109 vma_offset = m->sections[0]->vma % bed->maxpagesize;
5110 off_offset = off % bed->maxpagesize;
5111 if (vma_offset < off_offset)
5112 adjustment = vma_offset + bed->maxpagesize - off_offset;
5113 else
5114 adjustment = vma_offset - off_offset;
5115
5116 which can can be collapsed into the expression below. */
5117
5118 static file_ptr
5119 vma_page_aligned_bias (bfd_vma vma, ufile_ptr off, bfd_vma maxpagesize)
5120 {
5121 /* PR binutils/16199: Handle an alignment of zero. */
5122 if (maxpagesize == 0)
5123 maxpagesize = 1;
5124 return ((vma - off) % maxpagesize);
5125 }
5126
5127 static void
5128 print_segment_map (const struct elf_segment_map *m)
5129 {
5130 unsigned int j;
5131 const char *pt = get_segment_type (m->p_type);
5132 char buf[32];
5133
5134 if (pt == NULL)
5135 {
5136 if (m->p_type >= PT_LOPROC && m->p_type <= PT_HIPROC)
5137 sprintf (buf, "LOPROC+%7.7x",
5138 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOPROC));
5139 else if (m->p_type >= PT_LOOS && m->p_type <= PT_HIOS)
5140 sprintf (buf, "LOOS+%7.7x",
5141 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOOS));
5142 else
5143 snprintf (buf, sizeof (buf), "%8.8x",
5144 (unsigned int) m->p_type);
5145 pt = buf;
5146 }
5147 fflush (stdout);
5148 fprintf (stderr, "%s:", pt);
5149 for (j = 0; j < m->count; j++)
5150 fprintf (stderr, " %s", m->sections [j]->name);
5151 putc ('\n',stderr);
5152 fflush (stderr);
5153 }
5154
5155 static bfd_boolean
5156 write_zeros (bfd *abfd, file_ptr pos, bfd_size_type len)
5157 {
5158 void *buf;
5159 bfd_boolean ret;
5160
5161 if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0)
5162 return FALSE;
5163 buf = bfd_zmalloc (len);
5164 if (buf == NULL)
5165 return FALSE;
5166 ret = bfd_bwrite (buf, len, abfd) == len;
5167 free (buf);
5168 return ret;
5169 }
5170
5171 /* Assign file positions to the sections based on the mapping from
5172 sections to segments. This function also sets up some fields in
5173 the file header. */
5174
5175 static bfd_boolean
5176 assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
5177 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
5178 {
5179 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5180 struct elf_segment_map *m;
5181 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
5182 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
5183 file_ptr off;
5184 bfd_size_type maxpagesize;
5185 unsigned int pt_load_count = 0;
5186 unsigned int alloc;
5187 unsigned int i, j;
5188 bfd_vma header_pad = 0;
5189
5190 if (link_info == NULL
5191 && !_bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (abfd, link_info))
5192 return FALSE;
5193
5194 alloc = 0;
5195 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5196 {
5197 ++alloc;
5198 if (m->header_size)
5199 header_pad = m->header_size;
5200 }
5201
5202 if (alloc)
5203 {
5204 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5205 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5206 }
5207 else
5208 {
5209 /* PR binutils/12467. */
5210 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = 0;
5211 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = 0;
5212 }
5213
5214 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum = alloc;
5215
5216 if (elf_program_header_size (abfd) == (bfd_size_type) -1)
5217 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5218 else
5219 BFD_ASSERT (elf_program_header_size (abfd)
5220 >= alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr);
5221
5222 if (alloc == 0)
5223 {
5224 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5225 return TRUE;
5226 }
5227
5228 /* We're writing the size in elf_program_header_size (abfd),
5229 see assign_file_positions_except_relocs, so make sure we have
5230 that amount allocated, with trailing space cleared.
5231 The variable alloc contains the computed need, while
5232 elf_program_header_size (abfd) contains the size used for the
5233 layout.
5234 See ld/emultempl/elf-generic.em:gld${EMULATION_NAME}_map_segments
5235 where the layout is forced to according to a larger size in the
5236 last iterations for the testcase ld-elf/header. */
5237 BFD_ASSERT (elf_program_header_size (abfd) % bed->s->sizeof_phdr
5238 == 0);
5239 phdrs = (Elf_Internal_Phdr *)
5240 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd,
5241 (elf_program_header_size (abfd) / bed->s->sizeof_phdr),
5242 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
5243 elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr = phdrs;
5244 if (phdrs == NULL)
5245 return FALSE;
5246
5247 maxpagesize = 1;
5248 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
5249 maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
5250
5251 off = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5252 off += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5253 if (header_pad < (bfd_vma) off)
5254 header_pad = 0;
5255 else
5256 header_pad -= off;
5257 off += header_pad;
5258
5259 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs, j = 0;
5260 m != NULL;
5261 m = m->next, p++, j++)
5262 {
5263 asection **secpp;
5264 bfd_vma off_adjust;
5265 bfd_boolean no_contents;
5266
5267 /* If elf_segment_map is not from map_sections_to_segments, the
5268 sections may not be correctly ordered. NOTE: sorting should
5269 not be done to the PT_NOTE section of a corefile, which may
5270 contain several pseudo-sections artificially created by bfd.
5271 Sorting these pseudo-sections breaks things badly. */
5272 if (m->count > 1
5273 && !(elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_type == ET_CORE
5274 && m->p_type == PT_NOTE))
5275 qsort (m->sections, (size_t) m->count, sizeof (asection *),
5276 elf_sort_sections);
5277
5278 /* An ELF segment (described by Elf_Internal_Phdr) may contain a
5279 number of sections with contents contributing to both p_filesz
5280 and p_memsz, followed by a number of sections with no contents
5281 that just contribute to p_memsz. In this loop, OFF tracks next
5282 available file offset for PT_LOAD and PT_NOTE segments. */
5283 p->p_type = m->p_type;
5284 p->p_flags = m->p_flags;
5285
5286 if (m->count == 0)
5287 p->p_vaddr = 0;
5288 else
5289 p->p_vaddr = m->sections[0]->vma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
5290
5291 if (m->p_paddr_valid)
5292 p->p_paddr = m->p_paddr;
5293 else if (m->count == 0)
5294 p->p_paddr = 0;
5295 else
5296 p->p_paddr = m->sections[0]->lma - m->p_vaddr_offset;
5297
5298 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5299 && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
5300 {
5301 /* p_align in demand paged PT_LOAD segments effectively stores
5302 the maximum page size. When copying an executable with
5303 objcopy, we set m->p_align from the input file. Use this
5304 value for maxpagesize rather than bed->maxpagesize, which
5305 may be different. Note that we use maxpagesize for PT_TLS
5306 segment alignment later in this function, so we are relying
5307 on at least one PT_LOAD segment appearing before a PT_TLS
5308 segment. */
5309 if (m->p_align_valid)
5310 maxpagesize = m->p_align;
5311
5312 p->p_align = maxpagesize;
5313 pt_load_count += 1;
5314 }
5315 else if (m->p_align_valid)
5316 p->p_align = m->p_align;
5317 else if (m->count == 0)
5318 p->p_align = 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
5319 else
5320 p->p_align = 0;
5321
5322 no_contents = FALSE;
5323 off_adjust = 0;
5324 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5325 && m->count > 0)
5326 {
5327 bfd_size_type align;
5328 unsigned int align_power = 0;
5329
5330 if (m->p_align_valid)
5331 align = p->p_align;
5332 else
5333 {
5334 for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
5335 {
5336 unsigned int secalign;
5337
5338 secalign = bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, *secpp);
5339 if (secalign > align_power)
5340 align_power = secalign;
5341 }
5342 align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << align_power;
5343 if (align < maxpagesize)
5344 align = maxpagesize;
5345 }
5346
5347 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5348 if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
5349 /* If we aren't making room for this section, then
5350 it must be SHT_NOBITS regardless of what we've
5351 set via struct bfd_elf_special_section. */
5352 elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOBITS;
5353
5354 /* Find out whether this segment contains any loadable
5355 sections. */
5356 no_contents = TRUE;
5357 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5358 if (elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) != SHT_NOBITS)
5359 {
5360 no_contents = FALSE;
5361 break;
5362 }
5363
5364 off_adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (p->p_vaddr, off, align);
5365
5366 /* Broken hardware and/or kernel require that files do not
5367 map the same page with different permissions on some hppa
5368 processors. */
5369 if (pt_load_count > 1
5370 && bed->no_page_alias
5371 && (off & (maxpagesize - 1)) != 0
5372 && (off & -maxpagesize) == ((off + off_adjust) & -maxpagesize))
5373 off_adjust += maxpagesize;
5374 off += off_adjust;
5375 if (no_contents)
5376 {
5377 /* We shouldn't need to align the segment on disk since
5378 the segment doesn't need file space, but the gABI
5379 arguably requires the alignment and glibc ld.so
5380 checks it. So to comply with the alignment
5381 requirement but not waste file space, we adjust
5382 p_offset for just this segment. (OFF_ADJUST is
5383 subtracted from OFF later.) This may put p_offset
5384 past the end of file, but that shouldn't matter. */
5385 }
5386 else
5387 off_adjust = 0;
5388 }
5389 /* Make sure the .dynamic section is the first section in the
5390 PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
5391 else if (p->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC
5392 && m->count > 1
5393 && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") != 0)
5394 {
5395 _bfd_error_handler
5396 (_("%B: The first section in the PT_DYNAMIC segment is not the .dynamic section"),
5397 abfd);
5398 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5399 return FALSE;
5400 }
5401 /* Set the note section type to SHT_NOTE. */
5402 else if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE)
5403 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5404 elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOTE;
5405
5406 p->p_offset = 0;
5407 p->p_filesz = 0;
5408 p->p_memsz = 0;
5409
5410 if (m->includes_filehdr)
5411 {
5412 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5413 p->p_flags |= PF_R;
5414 p->p_filesz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5415 p->p_memsz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5416 if (m->count > 0)
5417 {
5418 if (p->p_vaddr < (bfd_vma) off
5419 || (!m->p_paddr_valid
5420 && p->p_paddr < (bfd_vma) off))
5421 {
5422 _bfd_error_handler
5423 (_("%B: Not enough room for program headers, try linking with -N"),
5424 abfd);
5425 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5426 return FALSE;
5427 }
5428
5429 p->p_vaddr -= off;
5430 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5431 p->p_paddr -= off;
5432 }
5433 }
5434
5435 if (m->includes_phdrs)
5436 {
5437 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5438 p->p_flags |= PF_R;
5439
5440 if (!m->includes_filehdr)
5441 {
5442 p->p_offset = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5443
5444 if (m->count > 0)
5445 {
5446 p->p_vaddr -= off - p->p_offset;
5447 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5448 p->p_paddr -= off - p->p_offset;
5449 }
5450 }
5451
5452 p->p_filesz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5453 p->p_memsz += alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5454 if (m->count)
5455 {
5456 p->p_filesz += header_pad;
5457 p->p_memsz += header_pad;
5458 }
5459 }
5460
5461 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5462 || (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core))
5463 {
5464 if (!m->includes_filehdr && !m->includes_phdrs)
5465 p->p_offset = off;
5466 else
5467 {
5468 file_ptr adjust;
5469
5470 adjust = off - (p->p_offset + p->p_filesz);
5471 if (!no_contents)
5472 p->p_filesz += adjust;
5473 p->p_memsz += adjust;
5474 }
5475 }
5476
5477 /* Set up p_filesz, p_memsz, p_align and p_flags from the section
5478 maps. Set filepos for sections in PT_LOAD segments, and in
5479 core files, for sections in PT_NOTE segments.
5480 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections will set filepos
5481 for other sections and update p_filesz for other segments. */
5482 for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
5483 {
5484 asection *sec;
5485 bfd_size_type align;
5486 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
5487
5488 sec = *secpp;
5489 this_hdr = &elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr;
5490 align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << bfd_get_section_alignment (abfd, sec);
5491
5492 if ((p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5493 || p->p_type == PT_TLS)
5494 && (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
5495 || ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
5496 && ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0
5497 || p->p_type == PT_TLS))))
5498 {
5499 bfd_vma p_start = p->p_paddr;
5500 bfd_vma p_end = p_start + p->p_memsz;
5501 bfd_vma s_start = sec->lma;
5502 bfd_vma adjust = s_start - p_end;
5503
5504 if (adjust != 0
5505 && (s_start < p_end
5506 || p_end < p_start))
5507 {
5508 _bfd_error_handler
5509 /* xgettext:c-format */
5510 (_("%B: section %A lma %#lx adjusted to %#lx"), abfd, sec,
5511 (unsigned long) s_start, (unsigned long) p_end);
5512 adjust = 0;
5513 sec->lma = p_end;
5514 }
5515 p->p_memsz += adjust;
5516
5517 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5518 {
5519 if (p->p_filesz + adjust < p->p_memsz)
5520 {
5521 /* We have a PROGBITS section following NOBITS ones.
5522 Allocate file space for the NOBITS section(s) and
5523 zero it. */
5524 adjust = p->p_memsz - p->p_filesz;
5525 if (!write_zeros (abfd, off, adjust))
5526 return FALSE;
5527 }
5528 off += adjust;
5529 p->p_filesz += adjust;
5530 }
5531 }
5532
5533 if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
5534 {
5535 /* The section at i == 0 is the one that actually contains
5536 everything. */
5537 if (i == 0)
5538 {
5539 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
5540 off += this_hdr->sh_size;
5541 p->p_filesz = this_hdr->sh_size;
5542 p->p_memsz = 0;
5543 p->p_align = 1;
5544 }
5545 else
5546 {
5547 /* The rest are fake sections that shouldn't be written. */
5548 sec->filepos = 0;
5549 sec->size = 0;
5550 sec->flags = 0;
5551 continue;
5552 }
5553 }
5554 else
5555 {
5556 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD)
5557 {
5558 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
5559 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5560 off += this_hdr->sh_size;
5561 }
5562 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
5563 && (this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0
5564 && this_hdr->sh_offset == 0)
5565 {
5566 /* This is a .tbss section that didn't get a PT_LOAD.
5567 (See _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments "Create a
5568 final PT_LOAD".) Set sh_offset to the value it
5569 would have if we had created a zero p_filesz and
5570 p_memsz PT_LOAD header for the section. This
5571 also makes the PT_TLS header have the same
5572 p_offset value. */
5573 bfd_vma adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (this_hdr->sh_addr,
5574 off, align);
5575 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off + adjust;
5576 }
5577
5578 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5579 {
5580 p->p_filesz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5581 /* A load section without SHF_ALLOC is something like
5582 a note section in a PT_NOTE segment. These take
5583 file space but are not loaded into memory. */
5584 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5585 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5586 }
5587 else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5588 {
5589 if (p->p_type == PT_TLS)
5590 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5591
5592 /* .tbss is special. It doesn't contribute to p_memsz of
5593 normal segments. */
5594 else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
5595 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5596 }
5597
5598 if (align > p->p_align
5599 && !m->p_align_valid
5600 && (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
5601 || (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0))
5602 p->p_align = align;
5603 }
5604
5605 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5606 {
5607 p->p_flags |= PF_R;
5608 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
5609 p->p_flags |= PF_X;
5610 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) != 0)
5611 p->p_flags |= PF_W;
5612 }
5613 }
5614
5615 off -= off_adjust;
5616
5617 /* Check that all sections are in a PT_LOAD segment.
5618 Don't check funky gdb generated core files. */
5619 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
5620 {
5621 bfd_boolean check_vma = TRUE;
5622
5623 for (i = 1; i < m->count; i++)
5624 if (m->sections[i]->vma == m->sections[i - 1]->vma
5625 && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i])
5626 ->this_hdr), p) != 0
5627 && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i - 1])
5628 ->this_hdr), p) != 0)
5629 {
5630 /* Looks like we have overlays packed into the segment. */
5631 check_vma = FALSE;
5632 break;
5633 }
5634
5635 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5636 {
5637 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
5638 asection *sec;
5639
5640 sec = m->sections[i];
5641 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(sec)->this_hdr);
5642 if (!ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT_1 (this_hdr, p, check_vma, 0)
5643 && !ELF_TBSS_SPECIAL (this_hdr, p))
5644 {
5645 _bfd_error_handler
5646 /* xgettext:c-format */
5647 (_("%B: section `%A' can't be allocated in segment %d"),
5648 abfd, sec, j);
5649 print_segment_map (m);
5650 }
5651 }
5652 }
5653 }
5654
5655 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
5656 return TRUE;
5657 }
5658
5659 /* Assign file positions for the other sections. */
5660
5661 static bfd_boolean
5662 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
5663 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
5664 {
5665 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5666 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrpp;
5667 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp, **end_hdrpp;
5668 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
5669 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
5670 struct elf_segment_map *m;
5671 struct elf_segment_map *hdrs_segment;
5672 bfd_vma filehdr_vaddr, filehdr_paddr;
5673 bfd_vma phdrs_vaddr, phdrs_paddr;
5674 file_ptr off;
5675 unsigned int count;
5676
5677 i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
5678 end_hdrpp = i_shdrpp + elf_numsections (abfd);
5679 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
5680 for (hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; hdrpp < end_hdrpp; hdrpp++)
5681 {
5682 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
5683
5684 hdr = *hdrpp;
5685 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
5686 && (hdr->bfd_section->filepos != 0
5687 || (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
5688 && hdr->contents == NULL)))
5689 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_offset == hdr->bfd_section->filepos);
5690 else if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5691 {
5692 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
5693 _bfd_error_handler
5694 /* xgettext:c-format */
5695 (_("%B: warning: allocated section `%s' not in segment"),
5696 abfd,
5697 (hdr->bfd_section == NULL
5698 ? "*unknown*"
5699 : hdr->bfd_section->name));
5700 /* We don't need to page align empty sections. */
5701 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0 && hdr->sh_size != 0)
5702 off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
5703 bed->maxpagesize);
5704 else
5705 off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
5706 hdr->sh_addralign);
5707 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off,
5708 FALSE);
5709 }
5710 else if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
5711 && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
5712 || (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
5713 && (hdr->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS))
5714 /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
5715 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]
5716 || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL
5717 && hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx])
5718 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)]
5719 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd)])
5720 hdr->sh_offset = -1;
5721 else
5722 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
5723 }
5724
5725 /* Now that we have set the section file positions, we can set up
5726 the file positions for the non PT_LOAD segments. */
5727 count = 0;
5728 filehdr_vaddr = 0;
5729 filehdr_paddr = 0;
5730 phdrs_vaddr = bed->maxpagesize + bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5731 phdrs_paddr = 0;
5732 hdrs_segment = NULL;
5733 phdrs = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
5734 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs; m != NULL; m = m->next, p++)
5735 {
5736 ++count;
5737 if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD)
5738 continue;
5739
5740 if (m->includes_filehdr)
5741 {
5742 filehdr_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
5743 filehdr_paddr = p->p_paddr;
5744 }
5745 if (m->includes_phdrs)
5746 {
5747 phdrs_vaddr = p->p_vaddr;
5748 phdrs_paddr = p->p_paddr;
5749 if (m->includes_filehdr)
5750 {
5751 hdrs_segment = m;
5752 phdrs_vaddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5753 phdrs_paddr += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5754 }
5755 }
5756 }
5757
5758 if (hdrs_segment != NULL && link_info != NULL)
5759 {
5760 /* There is a segment that contains both the file headers and the
5761 program headers, so provide a symbol __ehdr_start pointing there.
5762 A program can use this to examine itself robustly. */
5763
5764 struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash
5765 = elf_link_hash_lookup (elf_hash_table (link_info), "__ehdr_start",
5766 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
5767 /* If the symbol was referenced and not defined, define it. */
5768 if (hash != NULL
5769 && (hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new
5770 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
5771 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
5772 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_common))
5773 {
5774 asection *s = NULL;
5775 if (hdrs_segment->count != 0)
5776 /* The segment contains sections, so use the first one. */
5777 s = hdrs_segment->sections[0];
5778 else
5779 /* Use the first (i.e. lowest-addressed) section in any segment. */
5780 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5781 if (m->count != 0)
5782 {
5783 s = m->sections[0];
5784 break;
5785 }
5786
5787 if (s != NULL)
5788 {
5789 hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr - s->vma;
5790 hash->root.u.def.section = s;
5791 }
5792 else
5793 {
5794 hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr;
5795 hash->root.u.def.section = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
5796 }
5797
5798 hash->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5799 hash->def_regular = 1;
5800 hash->non_elf = 0;
5801 }
5802 }
5803
5804 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs; m != NULL; m = m->next, p++)
5805 {
5806 if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
5807 {
5808 const Elf_Internal_Phdr *lp;
5809 struct elf_segment_map *lm;
5810
5811 if (link_info != NULL)
5812 {
5813 /* During linking the range of the RELRO segment is passed
5814 in link_info. */
5815 for (lm = elf_seg_map (abfd), lp = phdrs;
5816 lm != NULL;
5817 lm = lm->next, lp++)
5818 {
5819 if (lp->p_type == PT_LOAD
5820 && lp->p_vaddr < link_info->relro_end
5821 && lm->count != 0
5822 && lm->sections[0]->vma >= link_info->relro_start)
5823 break;
5824 }
5825
5826 BFD_ASSERT (lm != NULL);
5827 }
5828 else
5829 {
5830 /* Otherwise we are copying an executable or shared
5831 library, but we need to use the same linker logic. */
5832 for (lp = phdrs; lp < phdrs + count; ++lp)
5833 {
5834 if (lp->p_type == PT_LOAD
5835 && lp->p_paddr == p->p_paddr)
5836 break;
5837 }
5838 }
5839
5840 if (lp < phdrs + count)
5841 {
5842 p->p_vaddr = lp->p_vaddr;
5843 p->p_paddr = lp->p_paddr;
5844 p->p_offset = lp->p_offset;
5845 if (link_info != NULL)
5846 p->p_filesz = link_info->relro_end - lp->p_vaddr;
5847 else if (m->p_size_valid)
5848 p->p_filesz = m->p_size;
5849 else
5850 abort ();
5851 p->p_memsz = p->p_filesz;
5852 /* Preserve the alignment and flags if they are valid. The
5853 gold linker generates RW/4 for the PT_GNU_RELRO section.
5854 It is better for objcopy/strip to honor these attributes
5855 otherwise gdb will choke when using separate debug files.
5856 */
5857 if (!m->p_align_valid)
5858 p->p_align = 1;
5859 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5860 p->p_flags = PF_R;
5861 }
5862 else
5863 {
5864 memset (p, 0, sizeof *p);
5865 p->p_type = PT_NULL;
5866 }
5867 }
5868 else if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
5869 {
5870 if (m->p_size_valid)
5871 p->p_memsz = m->p_size;
5872 }
5873 else if (m->count != 0)
5874 {
5875 unsigned int i;
5876
5877 if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
5878 && (p->p_type != PT_NOTE
5879 || bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core))
5880 {
5881 /* A user specified segment layout may include a PHDR
5882 segment that overlaps with a LOAD segment... */
5883 if (p->p_type == PT_PHDR)
5884 {
5885 m->count = 0;
5886 continue;
5887 }
5888
5889 if (m->includes_filehdr || m->includes_phdrs)
5890 {
5891 /* PR 17512: file: 2195325e. */
5892 _bfd_error_handler
5893 (_("%B: error: non-load segment %d includes file header and/or program header"),
5894 abfd, (int)(p - phdrs));
5895 return FALSE;
5896 }
5897
5898 p->p_filesz = 0;
5899 p->p_offset = m->sections[0]->filepos;
5900 for (i = m->count; i-- != 0;)
5901 {
5902 asection *sect = m->sections[i];
5903 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_section_data (sect)->this_hdr;
5904 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5905 {
5906 p->p_filesz = (sect->filepos - m->sections[0]->filepos
5907 + hdr->sh_size);
5908 break;
5909 }
5910 }
5911 }
5912 }
5913 else if (m->includes_filehdr)
5914 {
5915 p->p_vaddr = filehdr_vaddr;
5916 if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
5917 p->p_paddr = filehdr_paddr;
5918 }
5919 else if (m->includes_phdrs)
5920 {
5921 p->p_vaddr = phdrs_vaddr;
5922 if (! m->p_paddr_valid)
5923 p->p_paddr = phdrs_paddr;
5924 }
5925 }
5926
5927 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
5928
5929 return TRUE;
5930 }
5931
5932 static elf_section_list *
5933 find_section_in_list (unsigned int i, elf_section_list * list)
5934 {
5935 for (;list != NULL; list = list->next)
5936 if (list->ndx == i)
5937 break;
5938 return list;
5939 }
5940
5941 /* Work out the file positions of all the sections. This is called by
5942 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions. All the section sizes and
5943 VMAs must be known before this is called.
5944
5945 Reloc sections come in two flavours: Those processed specially as
5946 "side-channel" data attached to a section to which they apply, and
5947 those that bfd doesn't process as relocations. The latter sort are
5948 stored in a normal bfd section by bfd_section_from_shdr. We don't
5949 consider the former sort here, unless they form part of the loadable
5950 image. Reloc sections not assigned here will be handled later by
5951 assign_file_positions_for_relocs.
5952
5953 We also don't set the positions of the .symtab and .strtab here. */
5954
5955 static bfd_boolean
5956 assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *abfd,
5957 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
5958 {
5959 struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
5960 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
5961 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5962
5963 if ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) == 0
5964 && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
5965 {
5966 Elf_Internal_Shdr ** const i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
5967 unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
5968 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
5969 unsigned int i;
5970 file_ptr off;
5971
5972 /* Start after the ELF header. */
5973 off = i_ehdrp->e_ehsize;
5974
5975 /* We are not creating an executable, which means that we are
5976 not creating a program header, and that the actual order of
5977 the sections in the file is unimportant. */
5978 for (i = 1, hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; i < num_sec; i++, hdrpp++)
5979 {
5980 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
5981
5982 hdr = *hdrpp;
5983 if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
5984 && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
5985 || (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
5986 && (hdr->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS))
5987 /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
5988 || i == elf_onesymtab (abfd)
5989 || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL
5990 && hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx])
5991 || i == elf_strtab_sec (abfd)
5992 || i == elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd))
5993 {
5994 hdr->sh_offset = -1;
5995 }
5996 else
5997 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
5998 }
5999
6000 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6001 }
6002 else
6003 {
6004 unsigned int alloc;
6005
6006 /* Assign file positions for the loaded sections based on the
6007 assignment of sections to segments. */
6008 if (!assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
6009 return FALSE;
6010
6011 /* And for non-load sections. */
6012 if (!assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
6013 return FALSE;
6014
6015 if (bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers != NULL)
6016 {
6017 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_program_headers) (abfd, link_info))
6018 return FALSE;
6019 }
6020
6021 /* Set e_type in ELF header to ET_EXEC for -pie -Ttext-segment=. */
6022 if (link_info != NULL && bfd_link_pie (link_info))
6023 {
6024 unsigned int num_segments = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
6025 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
6026 Elf_Internal_Phdr *end_segment = &segment[num_segments];
6027
6028 /* Find the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD segments. */
6029 bfd_vma p_vaddr = (bfd_vma) -1;
6030 for (; segment < end_segment; segment++)
6031 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && p_vaddr > segment->p_vaddr)
6032 p_vaddr = segment->p_vaddr;
6033
6034 /* Set e_type to ET_EXEC if the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD
6035 segments is non-zero. */
6036 if (p_vaddr)
6037 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
6038 }
6039
6040 /* Write out the program headers. */
6041 alloc = elf_program_header_size (abfd) / bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
6042
6043 /* Sort the program headers into the ordering required by the ELF standard. */
6044 if (alloc == 0)
6045 return TRUE;
6046
6047 /* PR ld/20815 - Check that the program header segment, if present, will
6048 be loaded into memory. FIXME: The check below is not sufficient as
6049 really all PT_LOAD segments should be checked before issuing an error
6050 message. Plus the PHDR segment does not have to be the first segment
6051 in the program header table. But this version of the check should
6052 catch all real world use cases.
6053
6054 FIXME: We used to have code here to sort the PT_LOAD segments into
6055 ascending order, as per the ELF spec. But this breaks some programs,
6056 including the Linux kernel. But really either the spec should be
6057 changed or the programs updated. */
6058 if (alloc > 1
6059 && tdata->phdr[0].p_type == PT_PHDR
6060 && ! bed->elf_backend_allow_non_load_phdr (abfd, tdata->phdr, alloc)
6061 && tdata->phdr[1].p_type == PT_LOAD
6062 && (tdata->phdr[1].p_vaddr > tdata->phdr[0].p_vaddr
6063 || (tdata->phdr[1].p_vaddr + tdata->phdr[1].p_memsz)
6064 < (tdata->phdr[0].p_vaddr + tdata->phdr[0].p_memsz)))
6065 {
6066 /* The fix for this error is usually to edit the linker script being
6067 used and set up the program headers manually. Either that or
6068 leave room for the headers at the start of the SECTIONS. */
6069 _bfd_error_handler (_("\
6070 %B: error: PHDR segment not covered by LOAD segment"),
6071 abfd);
6072 return FALSE;
6073 }
6074
6075 if (bfd_seek (abfd, (bfd_signed_vma) bed->s->sizeof_ehdr, SEEK_SET) != 0
6076 || bed->s->write_out_phdrs (abfd, tdata->phdr, alloc) != 0)
6077 return FALSE;
6078 }
6079
6080 return TRUE;
6081 }
6082
6083 static bfd_boolean
6084 prep_headers (bfd *abfd)
6085 {
6086 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp; /* Elf file header, internal form. */
6087 struct elf_strtab_hash *shstrtab;
6088 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6089
6090 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6091
6092 shstrtab = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
6093 if (shstrtab == NULL)
6094 return FALSE;
6095
6096 elf_shstrtab (abfd) = shstrtab;
6097
6098 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG0] = ELFMAG0;
6099 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG1] = ELFMAG1;
6100 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG2] = ELFMAG2;
6101 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG3] = ELFMAG3;
6102
6103 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_CLASS] = bed->s->elfclass;
6104 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_DATA] =
6105 bfd_big_endian (abfd) ? ELFDATA2MSB : ELFDATA2LSB;
6106 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_VERSION] = bed->s->ev_current;
6107
6108 if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
6109 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_DYN;
6110 else if ((abfd->flags & EXEC_P) != 0)
6111 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
6112 else if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
6113 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_CORE;
6114 else
6115 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_REL;
6116
6117 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
6118 {
6119 case bfd_arch_unknown:
6120 i_ehdrp->e_machine = EM_NONE;
6121 break;
6122
6123 /* There used to be a long list of cases here, each one setting
6124 e_machine to the same EM_* macro #defined as ELF_MACHINE_CODE
6125 in the corresponding bfd definition. To avoid duplication,
6126 the switch was removed. Machines that need special handling
6127 can generally do it in elf_backend_final_write_processing(),
6128 unless they need the information earlier than the final write.
6129 Such need can generally be supplied by replacing the tests for
6130 e_machine with the conditions used to determine it. */
6131 default:
6132 i_ehdrp->e_machine = bed->elf_machine_code;
6133 }
6134
6135 i_ehdrp->e_version = bed->s->ev_current;
6136 i_ehdrp->e_ehsize = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
6137
6138 /* No program header, for now. */
6139 i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
6140 i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
6141 i_ehdrp->e_phnum = 0;
6142
6143 /* Each bfd section is section header entry. */
6144 i_ehdrp->e_entry = bfd_get_start_address (abfd);
6145 i_ehdrp->e_shentsize = bed->s->sizeof_shdr;
6146
6147 /* If we're building an executable, we'll need a program header table. */
6148 if (abfd->flags & EXEC_P)
6149 /* It all happens later. */
6150 ;
6151 else
6152 {
6153 i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
6154 i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
6155 }
6156
6157 elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name =
6158 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".symtab", FALSE);
6159 elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name =
6160 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".strtab", FALSE);
6161 elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name =
6162 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".shstrtab", FALSE);
6163 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
6164 || elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
6165 || elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
6166 return FALSE;
6167
6168 return TRUE;
6169 }
6170
6171 /* Assign file positions for all the reloc sections which are not part
6172 of the loadable file image, and the file position of section headers. */
6173
6174 static bfd_boolean
6175 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (bfd *abfd)
6176 {
6177 file_ptr off;
6178 Elf_Internal_Shdr **shdrpp, **end_shdrpp;
6179 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdrp;
6180 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp;
6181 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6182
6183 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
6184
6185 shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6186 end_shdrpp = shdrpp + elf_numsections (abfd);
6187 for (shdrpp++; shdrpp < end_shdrpp; shdrpp++)
6188 {
6189 shdrp = *shdrpp;
6190 if (shdrp->sh_offset == -1)
6191 {
6192 asection *sec = shdrp->bfd_section;
6193 bfd_boolean is_rel = (shdrp->sh_type == SHT_REL
6194 || shdrp->sh_type == SHT_RELA);
6195 if (is_rel
6196 || (sec != NULL && (sec->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS)))
6197 {
6198 if (!is_rel)
6199 {
6200 const char *name = sec->name;
6201 struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
6202
6203 /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
6204 if (!bfd_compress_section (abfd, sec,
6205 shdrp->contents))
6206 return FALSE;
6207
6208 if (sec->compress_status == COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE
6209 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) == 0)
6210 {
6211 /* If section is compressed with zlib-gnu, convert
6212 section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_*. */
6213 char *new_name
6214 = convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd, name);
6215 if (new_name == NULL)
6216 return FALSE;
6217 name = new_name;
6218 }
6219 /* Add section name to section name section. */
6220 if (shdrp->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
6221 abort ();
6222 shdrp->sh_name
6223 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
6224 name, FALSE);
6225 d = elf_section_data (sec);
6226
6227 /* Add reloc section name to section name section. */
6228 if (d->rel.hdr
6229 && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd,
6230 d->rel.hdr,
6231 name, FALSE))
6232 return FALSE;
6233 if (d->rela.hdr
6234 && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd,
6235 d->rela.hdr,
6236 name, TRUE))
6237 return FALSE;
6238
6239 /* Update section size and contents. */
6240 shdrp->sh_size = sec->size;
6241 shdrp->contents = sec->contents;
6242 shdrp->bfd_section->contents = NULL;
6243 }
6244 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp,
6245 off,
6246 TRUE);
6247 }
6248 }
6249 }
6250
6251 /* Place section name section after DWARF debug sections have been
6252 compressed. */
6253 _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
6254 shdrp = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
6255 shdrp->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
6256 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp, off, TRUE);
6257
6258 /* Place the section headers. */
6259 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6260 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6261 off = align_file_position (off, 1 << bed->s->log_file_align);
6262 i_ehdrp->e_shoff = off;
6263 off += i_ehdrp->e_shnum * i_ehdrp->e_shentsize;
6264 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6265
6266 return TRUE;
6267 }
6268
6269 bfd_boolean
6270 _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (bfd *abfd)
6271 {
6272 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6273 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
6274 bfd_boolean failed;
6275 unsigned int count, num_sec;
6276 struct elf_obj_tdata *t;
6277
6278 if (! abfd->output_has_begun
6279 && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
6280 return FALSE;
6281
6282 i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6283
6284 failed = FALSE;
6285 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bed->s->write_relocs, &failed);
6286 if (failed)
6287 return FALSE;
6288
6289 if (!_bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (abfd))
6290 return FALSE;
6291
6292 /* After writing the headers, we need to write the sections too... */
6293 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
6294 for (count = 1; count < num_sec; count++)
6295 {
6296 i_shdrp[count]->sh_name
6297 = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
6298 i_shdrp[count]->sh_name);
6299 if (bed->elf_backend_section_processing)
6300 (*bed->elf_backend_section_processing) (abfd, i_shdrp[count]);
6301 if (i_shdrp[count]->contents)
6302 {
6303 bfd_size_type amt = i_shdrp[count]->sh_size;
6304
6305 if (bfd_seek (abfd, i_shdrp[count]->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
6306 || bfd_bwrite (i_shdrp[count]->contents, amt, abfd) != amt)
6307 return FALSE;
6308 }
6309 }
6310
6311 /* Write out the section header names. */
6312 t = elf_tdata (abfd);
6313 if (elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL
6314 && (bfd_seek (abfd, t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
6315 || !_bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, elf_shstrtab (abfd))))
6316 return FALSE;
6317
6318 if (bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing)
6319 (*bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing) (abfd, elf_linker (abfd));
6320
6321 if (!bed->s->write_shdrs_and_ehdr (abfd))
6322 return FALSE;
6323
6324 /* This is last since write_shdrs_and_ehdr can touch i_shdrp[0]. */
6325 if (t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents != NULL)
6326 return (*t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents) (abfd);
6327
6328 return TRUE;
6329 }
6330
6331 bfd_boolean
6332 _bfd_elf_write_corefile_contents (bfd *abfd)
6333 {
6334 /* Hopefully this can be done just like an object file. */
6335 return _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (abfd);
6336 }
6337
6338 /* Given a section, search the header to find them. */
6339
6340 unsigned int
6341 _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_section *asect)
6342 {
6343 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6344 unsigned int sec_index;
6345
6346 if (elf_section_data (asect) != NULL
6347 && elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx != 0)
6348 return elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx;
6349
6350 if (bfd_is_abs_section (asect))
6351 sec_index = SHN_ABS;
6352 else if (bfd_is_com_section (asect))
6353 sec_index = SHN_COMMON;
6354 else if (bfd_is_und_section (asect))
6355 sec_index = SHN_UNDEF;
6356 else
6357 sec_index = SHN_BAD;
6358
6359 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6360 if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section)
6361 {
6362 int retval = sec_index;
6363
6364 if ((*bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section) (abfd, asect, &retval))
6365 return retval;
6366 }
6367
6368 if (sec_index == SHN_BAD)
6369 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
6370
6371 return sec_index;
6372 }
6373
6374 /* Given a BFD symbol, return the index in the ELF symbol table, or -1
6375 on error. */
6376
6377 int
6378 _bfd_elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol (bfd *abfd, asymbol **asym_ptr_ptr)
6379 {
6380 asymbol *asym_ptr = *asym_ptr_ptr;
6381 int idx;
6382 flagword flags = asym_ptr->flags;
6383
6384 /* When gas creates relocations against local labels, it creates its
6385 own symbol for the section, but does put the symbol into the
6386 symbol chain, so udata is 0. When the linker is generating
6387 relocatable output, this section symbol may be for one of the
6388 input sections rather than the output section. */
6389 if (asym_ptr->udata.i == 0
6390 && (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
6391 && asym_ptr->section)
6392 {
6393 asection *sec;
6394 int indx;
6395
6396 sec = asym_ptr->section;
6397 if (sec->owner != abfd && sec->output_section != NULL)
6398 sec = sec->output_section;
6399 if (sec->owner == abfd
6400 && (indx = sec->index) < elf_num_section_syms (abfd)
6401 && elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx] != NULL)
6402 asym_ptr->udata.i = elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx]->udata.i;
6403 }
6404
6405 idx = asym_ptr->udata.i;
6406
6407 if (idx == 0)
6408 {
6409 /* This case can occur when using --strip-symbol on a symbol
6410 which is used in a relocation entry. */
6411 _bfd_error_handler
6412 /* xgettext:c-format */
6413 (_("%B: symbol `%s' required but not present"),
6414 abfd, bfd_asymbol_name (asym_ptr));
6415 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_symbols);
6416 return -1;
6417 }
6418
6419 #if DEBUG & 4
6420 {
6421 fprintf (stderr,
6422 "elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol 0x%.8lx, name = %s, sym num = %d, flags = 0x%.8lx\n",
6423 (long) asym_ptr, asym_ptr->name, idx, (long) flags);
6424 fflush (stderr);
6425 }
6426 #endif
6427
6428 return idx;
6429 }
6430
6431 /* Rewrite program header information. */
6432
6433 static bfd_boolean
6434 rewrite_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
6435 {
6436 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
6437 struct elf_segment_map *map;
6438 struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
6439 struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
6440 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
6441 asection *section;
6442 unsigned int i;
6443 unsigned int num_segments;
6444 bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
6445 bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
6446 bfd_vma maxpagesize;
6447 struct elf_segment_map *phdr_adjust_seg = NULL;
6448 unsigned int phdr_adjust_num = 0;
6449 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6450
6451 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
6452 iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
6453
6454 map_first = NULL;
6455 pointer_to_map = &map_first;
6456
6457 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
6458 maxpagesize = get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize;
6459
6460 /* Returns the end address of the segment + 1. */
6461 #define SEGMENT_END(segment, start) \
6462 (start + (segment->p_memsz > segment->p_filesz \
6463 ? segment->p_memsz : segment->p_filesz))
6464
6465 #define SECTION_SIZE(section, segment) \
6466 (((section->flags & (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
6467 != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL || segment->p_type == PT_TLS) \
6468 ? section->size : 0)
6469
6470 /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
6471 the given segment. VMA addresses are compared. */
6472 #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA(section, segment) \
6473 (section->vma >= segment->p_vaddr \
6474 && (section->vma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
6475 <= (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr))))
6476
6477 /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
6478 the given segment. LMA addresses are compared. */
6479 #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA(section, segment, base) \
6480 (section->lma >= base \
6481 && (section->lma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
6482 <= SEGMENT_END (segment, base)))
6483
6484 /* Handle PT_NOTE segment. */
6485 #define IS_NOTE(p, s) \
6486 (p->p_type == PT_NOTE \
6487 && elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE \
6488 && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
6489 && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
6490 <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
6491
6492 /* Special case: corefile "NOTE" section containing regs, prpsinfo
6493 etc. */
6494 #define IS_COREFILE_NOTE(p, s) \
6495 (IS_NOTE (p, s) \
6496 && bfd_get_format (ibfd) == bfd_core \
6497 && s->vma == 0 \
6498 && s->lma == 0)
6499
6500 /* The complicated case when p_vaddr is 0 is to handle the Solaris
6501 linker, which generates a PT_INTERP section with p_vaddr and
6502 p_memsz set to 0. */
6503 #define IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP(p, s) \
6504 (p->p_vaddr == 0 \
6505 && p->p_paddr == 0 \
6506 && p->p_memsz == 0 \
6507 && p->p_filesz > 0 \
6508 && (s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0 \
6509 && s->size > 0 \
6510 && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
6511 && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
6512 <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
6513
6514 /* Decide if the given section should be included in the given segment.
6515 A section will be included if:
6516 1. It is within the address space of the segment -- we use the LMA
6517 if that is set for the segment and the VMA otherwise,
6518 2. It is an allocated section or a NOTE section in a PT_NOTE
6519 segment.
6520 3. There is an output section associated with it,
6521 4. The section has not already been allocated to a previous segment.
6522 5. PT_GNU_STACK segments do not include any sections.
6523 6. PT_TLS segment includes only SHF_TLS sections.
6524 7. SHF_TLS sections are only in PT_TLS or PT_LOAD segments.
6525 8. PT_DYNAMIC should not contain empty sections at the beginning
6526 (with the possible exception of .dynamic). */
6527 #define IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed) \
6528 ((((segment->p_paddr \
6529 ? IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (section, segment, segment->p_paddr) \
6530 : IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (section, segment)) \
6531 && (section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) \
6532 || IS_NOTE (segment, section)) \
6533 && segment->p_type != PT_GNU_STACK \
6534 && (segment->p_type != PT_TLS \
6535 || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
6536 && (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD \
6537 || segment->p_type == PT_TLS \
6538 || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0) \
6539 && (segment->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC \
6540 || SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) > 0 \
6541 || (segment->p_paddr \
6542 ? segment->p_paddr != section->lma \
6543 : segment->p_vaddr != section->vma) \
6544 || (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (ibfd, section), ".dynamic") \
6545 == 0)) \
6546 && !section->segment_mark)
6547
6548 /* If the output section of a section in the input segment is NULL,
6549 it is removed from the corresponding output segment. */
6550 #define INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed) \
6551 (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed) \
6552 && section->output_section != NULL)
6553
6554 /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 starts after the end of seg2. */
6555 #define SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT(seg1, seg2, field) \
6556 (seg1->field >= SEGMENT_END (seg2, seg2->field))
6557
6558 /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 and seg2 overlap. Segments overlap iff both
6559 their VMA address ranges and their LMA address ranges overlap.
6560 It is possible to have overlapping VMA ranges without overlapping LMA
6561 ranges. RedBoot images for example can have both .data and .bss mapped
6562 to the same VMA range, but with the .data section mapped to a different
6563 LMA. */
6564 #define SEGMENT_OVERLAPS(seg1, seg2) \
6565 ( !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_vaddr) \
6566 || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_vaddr)) \
6567 && !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_paddr) \
6568 || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_paddr)))
6569
6570 /* Initialise the segment mark field. */
6571 for (section = ibfd->sections; section != NULL; section = section->next)
6572 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
6573
6574 /* The Solaris linker creates program headers in which all the
6575 p_paddr fields are zero. When we try to objcopy or strip such a
6576 file, we get confused. Check for this case, and if we find it
6577 don't set the p_paddr_valid fields. */
6578 p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
6579 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6580 i < num_segments;
6581 i++, segment++)
6582 if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
6583 {
6584 p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
6585 break;
6586 }
6587
6588 /* Scan through the segments specified in the program header
6589 of the input BFD. For this first scan we look for overlaps
6590 in the loadable segments. These can be created by weird
6591 parameters to objcopy. Also, fix some solaris weirdness. */
6592 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6593 i < num_segments;
6594 i++, segment++)
6595 {
6596 unsigned int j;
6597 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment2;
6598
6599 if (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP)
6600 for (section = ibfd->sections; section; section = section->next)
6601 if (IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP (segment, section))
6602 {
6603 /* Mininal change so that the normal section to segment
6604 assignment code will work. */
6605 segment->p_vaddr = section->vma;
6606 break;
6607 }
6608
6609 if (segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
6610 {
6611 /* Remove PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
6612 if (segment->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
6613 segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
6614 continue;
6615 }
6616
6617 /* Determine if this segment overlaps any previous segments. */
6618 for (j = 0, segment2 = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr; j < i; j++, segment2++)
6619 {
6620 bfd_signed_vma extra_length;
6621
6622 if (segment2->p_type != PT_LOAD
6623 || !SEGMENT_OVERLAPS (segment, segment2))
6624 continue;
6625
6626 /* Merge the two segments together. */
6627 if (segment2->p_vaddr < segment->p_vaddr)
6628 {
6629 /* Extend SEGMENT2 to include SEGMENT and then delete
6630 SEGMENT. */
6631 extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr)
6632 - SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr));
6633
6634 if (extra_length > 0)
6635 {
6636 segment2->p_memsz += extra_length;
6637 segment2->p_filesz += extra_length;
6638 }
6639
6640 segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
6641
6642 /* Since we have deleted P we must restart the outer loop. */
6643 i = 0;
6644 segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6645 break;
6646 }
6647 else
6648 {
6649 /* Extend SEGMENT to include SEGMENT2 and then delete
6650 SEGMENT2. */
6651 extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr)
6652 - SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr));
6653
6654 if (extra_length > 0)
6655 {
6656 segment->p_memsz += extra_length;
6657 segment->p_filesz += extra_length;
6658 }
6659
6660 segment2->p_type = PT_NULL;
6661 }
6662 }
6663 }
6664
6665 /* The second scan attempts to assign sections to segments. */
6666 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6667 i < num_segments;
6668 i++, segment++)
6669 {
6670 unsigned int section_count;
6671 asection **sections;
6672 asection *output_section;
6673 unsigned int isec;
6674 bfd_vma matching_lma;
6675 bfd_vma suggested_lma;
6676 unsigned int j;
6677 bfd_size_type amt;
6678 asection *first_section;
6679 bfd_boolean first_matching_lma;
6680 bfd_boolean first_suggested_lma;
6681
6682 if (segment->p_type == PT_NULL)
6683 continue;
6684
6685 first_section = NULL;
6686 /* Compute how many sections might be placed into this segment. */
6687 for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
6688 section != NULL;
6689 section = section->next)
6690 {
6691 /* Find the first section in the input segment, which may be
6692 removed from the corresponding output segment. */
6693 if (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
6694 {
6695 if (first_section == NULL)
6696 first_section = section;
6697 if (section->output_section != NULL)
6698 ++section_count;
6699 }
6700 }
6701
6702 /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
6703 all of the sections we have selected. */
6704 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
6705 amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
6706 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
6707 if (map == NULL)
6708 return FALSE;
6709
6710 /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Default to
6711 using the physical address of the segment in the input BFD. */
6712 map->next = NULL;
6713 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
6714 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
6715 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
6716
6717 /* If the first section in the input segment is removed, there is
6718 no need to preserve segment physical address in the corresponding
6719 output segment. */
6720 if (!first_section || first_section->output_section != NULL)
6721 {
6722 map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
6723 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
6724 }
6725
6726 /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
6727 and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
6728 map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
6729 && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
6730 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
6731
6732 if (!phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
6733 {
6734 map->includes_phdrs =
6735 (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
6736 && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
6737 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
6738 + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
6739
6740 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
6741 phdr_included = TRUE;
6742 }
6743
6744 if (section_count == 0)
6745 {
6746 /* Special segments, such as the PT_PHDR segment, may contain
6747 no sections, but ordinary, loadable segments should contain
6748 something. They are allowed by the ELF spec however, so only
6749 a warning is produced.
6750 There is however the valid use case of embedded systems which
6751 have segments with p_filesz of 0 and a p_memsz > 0 to initialize
6752 flash memory with zeros. No warning is shown for that case. */
6753 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD
6754 && (segment->p_filesz > 0 || segment->p_memsz == 0))
6755 /* xgettext:c-format */
6756 _bfd_error_handler (_("\
6757 %B: warning: Empty loadable segment detected at vaddr=0x%.8x, is this intentional ?"),
6758 ibfd, segment->p_vaddr);
6759
6760 map->count = 0;
6761 *pointer_to_map = map;
6762 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
6763
6764 continue;
6765 }
6766
6767 /* Now scan the sections in the input BFD again and attempt
6768 to add their corresponding output sections to the segment map.
6769 The problem here is how to handle an output section which has
6770 been moved (ie had its LMA changed). There are four possibilities:
6771
6772 1. None of the sections have been moved.
6773 In this case we can continue to use the segment LMA from the
6774 input BFD.
6775
6776 2. All of the sections have been moved by the same amount.
6777 In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
6778 of the first section.
6779
6780 3. Some of the sections have been moved, others have not.
6781 In this case those sections which have not been moved can be
6782 placed in the current segment which will have to have its size,
6783 and possibly its LMA changed, and a new segment or segments will
6784 have to be created to contain the other sections.
6785
6786 4. The sections have been moved, but not by the same amount.
6787 In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
6788 of the first section and we will have to create a new segment
6789 or segments to contain the other sections.
6790
6791 In order to save time, we allocate an array to hold the section
6792 pointers that we are interested in. As these sections get assigned
6793 to a segment, they are removed from this array. */
6794
6795 sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc2 (section_count, sizeof (asection *));
6796 if (sections == NULL)
6797 return FALSE;
6798
6799 /* Step One: Scan for segment vs section LMA conflicts.
6800 Also add the sections to the section array allocated above.
6801 Also add the sections to the current segment. In the common
6802 case, where the sections have not been moved, this means that
6803 we have completely filled the segment, and there is nothing
6804 more to do. */
6805 isec = 0;
6806 matching_lma = 0;
6807 suggested_lma = 0;
6808 first_matching_lma = TRUE;
6809 first_suggested_lma = TRUE;
6810
6811 for (section = first_section, j = 0;
6812 section != NULL;
6813 section = section->next)
6814 {
6815 if (INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed))
6816 {
6817 output_section = section->output_section;
6818
6819 sections[j++] = section;
6820
6821 /* The Solaris native linker always sets p_paddr to 0.
6822 We try to catch that case here, and set it to the
6823 correct value. Note - some backends require that
6824 p_paddr be left as zero. */
6825 if (!p_paddr_valid
6826 && segment->p_vaddr != 0
6827 && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
6828 && isec == 0
6829 && output_section->lma != 0
6830 && output_section->vma == (segment->p_vaddr
6831 + (map->includes_filehdr
6832 ? iehdr->e_ehsize
6833 : 0)
6834 + (map->includes_phdrs
6835 ? (iehdr->e_phnum
6836 * iehdr->e_phentsize)
6837 : 0)))
6838 map->p_paddr = segment->p_vaddr;
6839
6840 /* Match up the physical address of the segment with the
6841 LMA address of the output section. */
6842 if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
6843 || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section)
6844 || (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
6845 && IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (output_section, segment)))
6846 {
6847 if (first_matching_lma || output_section->lma < matching_lma)
6848 {
6849 matching_lma = output_section->lma;
6850 first_matching_lma = FALSE;
6851 }
6852
6853 /* We assume that if the section fits within the segment
6854 then it does not overlap any other section within that
6855 segment. */
6856 map->sections[isec++] = output_section;
6857 }
6858 else if (first_suggested_lma)
6859 {
6860 suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
6861 first_suggested_lma = FALSE;
6862 }
6863
6864 if (j == section_count)
6865 break;
6866 }
6867 }
6868
6869 BFD_ASSERT (j == section_count);
6870
6871 /* Step Two: Adjust the physical address of the current segment,
6872 if necessary. */
6873 if (isec == section_count)
6874 {
6875 /* All of the sections fitted within the segment as currently
6876 specified. This is the default case. Add the segment to
6877 the list of built segments and carry on to process the next
6878 program header in the input BFD. */
6879 map->count = section_count;
6880 *pointer_to_map = map;
6881 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
6882
6883 if (p_paddr_valid
6884 && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
6885 && matching_lma != map->p_paddr
6886 && !map->includes_filehdr
6887 && !map->includes_phdrs)
6888 /* There is some padding before the first section in the
6889 segment. So, we must account for that in the output
6890 segment's vma. */
6891 map->p_vaddr_offset = matching_lma - map->p_paddr;
6892
6893 free (sections);
6894 continue;
6895 }
6896 else
6897 {
6898 if (!first_matching_lma)
6899 {
6900 /* At least one section fits inside the current segment.
6901 Keep it, but modify its physical address to match the
6902 LMA of the first section that fitted. */
6903 map->p_paddr = matching_lma;
6904 }
6905 else
6906 {
6907 /* None of the sections fitted inside the current segment.
6908 Change the current segment's physical address to match
6909 the LMA of the first section. */
6910 map->p_paddr = suggested_lma;
6911 }
6912
6913 /* Offset the segment physical address from the lma
6914 to allow for space taken up by elf headers. */
6915 if (map->includes_filehdr)
6916 {
6917 if (map->p_paddr >= iehdr->e_ehsize)
6918 map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_ehsize;
6919 else
6920 {
6921 map->includes_filehdr = FALSE;
6922 map->includes_phdrs = FALSE;
6923 }
6924 }
6925
6926 if (map->includes_phdrs)
6927 {
6928 if (map->p_paddr >= iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)
6929 {
6930 map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize;
6931
6932 /* iehdr->e_phnum is just an estimate of the number
6933 of program headers that we will need. Make a note
6934 here of the number we used and the segment we chose
6935 to hold these headers, so that we can adjust the
6936 offset when we know the correct value. */
6937 phdr_adjust_num = iehdr->e_phnum;
6938 phdr_adjust_seg = map;
6939 }
6940 else
6941 map->includes_phdrs = FALSE;
6942 }
6943 }
6944
6945 /* Step Three: Loop over the sections again, this time assigning
6946 those that fit to the current segment and removing them from the
6947 sections array; but making sure not to leave large gaps. Once all
6948 possible sections have been assigned to the current segment it is
6949 added to the list of built segments and if sections still remain
6950 to be assigned, a new segment is constructed before repeating
6951 the loop. */
6952 isec = 0;
6953 do
6954 {
6955 map->count = 0;
6956 suggested_lma = 0;
6957 first_suggested_lma = TRUE;
6958
6959 /* Fill the current segment with sections that fit. */
6960 for (j = 0; j < section_count; j++)
6961 {
6962 section = sections[j];
6963
6964 if (section == NULL)
6965 continue;
6966
6967 output_section = section->output_section;
6968
6969 BFD_ASSERT (output_section != NULL);
6970
6971 if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr)
6972 || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section))
6973 {
6974 if (map->count == 0)
6975 {
6976 /* If the first section in a segment does not start at
6977 the beginning of the segment, then something is
6978 wrong. */
6979 if (output_section->lma
6980 != (map->p_paddr
6981 + (map->includes_filehdr ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0)
6982 + (map->includes_phdrs
6983 ? iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize
6984 : 0)))
6985 abort ();
6986 }
6987 else
6988 {
6989 asection *prev_sec;
6990
6991 prev_sec = map->sections[map->count - 1];
6992
6993 /* If the gap between the end of the previous section
6994 and the start of this section is more than
6995 maxpagesize then we need to start a new segment. */
6996 if ((BFD_ALIGN (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size,
6997 maxpagesize)
6998 < BFD_ALIGN (output_section->lma, maxpagesize))
6999 || (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size
7000 > output_section->lma))
7001 {
7002 if (first_suggested_lma)
7003 {
7004 suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
7005 first_suggested_lma = FALSE;
7006 }
7007
7008 continue;
7009 }
7010 }
7011
7012 map->sections[map->count++] = output_section;
7013 ++isec;
7014 sections[j] = NULL;
7015 section->segment_mark = TRUE;
7016 }
7017 else if (first_suggested_lma)
7018 {
7019 suggested_lma = output_section->lma;
7020 first_suggested_lma = FALSE;
7021 }
7022 }
7023
7024 BFD_ASSERT (map->count > 0);
7025
7026 /* Add the current segment to the list of built segments. */
7027 *pointer_to_map = map;
7028 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7029
7030 if (isec < section_count)
7031 {
7032 /* We still have not allocated all of the sections to
7033 segments. Create a new segment here, initialise it
7034 and carry on looping. */
7035 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
7036 amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
7037 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
7038 if (map == NULL)
7039 {
7040 free (sections);
7041 return FALSE;
7042 }
7043
7044 /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Set the physical
7045 physical address to the LMA of the first section that has
7046 not yet been assigned. */
7047 map->next = NULL;
7048 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
7049 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
7050 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
7051 map->p_paddr = suggested_lma;
7052 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
7053 map->includes_filehdr = 0;
7054 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
7055 }
7056 }
7057 while (isec < section_count);
7058
7059 free (sections);
7060 }
7061
7062 elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
7063
7064 /* If we had to estimate the number of program headers that were
7065 going to be needed, then check our estimate now and adjust
7066 the offset if necessary. */
7067 if (phdr_adjust_seg != NULL)
7068 {
7069 unsigned int count;
7070
7071 for (count = 0, map = map_first; map != NULL; map = map->next)
7072 count++;
7073
7074 if (count > phdr_adjust_num)
7075 phdr_adjust_seg->p_paddr
7076 -= (count - phdr_adjust_num) * iehdr->e_phentsize;
7077 }
7078
7079 #undef SEGMENT_END
7080 #undef SECTION_SIZE
7081 #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA
7082 #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA
7083 #undef IS_NOTE
7084 #undef IS_COREFILE_NOTE
7085 #undef IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP
7086 #undef IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT
7087 #undef INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT
7088 #undef SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT
7089 #undef SEGMENT_OVERLAPS
7090 return TRUE;
7091 }
7092
7093 /* Copy ELF program header information. */
7094
7095 static bfd_boolean
7096 copy_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7097 {
7098 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
7099 struct elf_segment_map *map;
7100 struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
7101 struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
7102 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7103 unsigned int i;
7104 unsigned int num_segments;
7105 bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
7106 bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
7107
7108 iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
7109
7110 map_first = NULL;
7111 pointer_to_map = &map_first;
7112
7113 /* If all the segment p_paddr fields are zero, don't set
7114 map->p_paddr_valid. */
7115 p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
7116 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7117 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7118 i < num_segments;
7119 i++, segment++)
7120 if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
7121 {
7122 p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
7123 break;
7124 }
7125
7126 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7127 i < num_segments;
7128 i++, segment++)
7129 {
7130 asection *section;
7131 unsigned int section_count;
7132 bfd_size_type amt;
7133 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
7134 asection *first_section = NULL;
7135 asection *lowest_section;
7136
7137 /* Compute how many sections are in this segment. */
7138 for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
7139 section != NULL;
7140 section = section->next)
7141 {
7142 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7143 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7144 {
7145 if (first_section == NULL)
7146 first_section = section;
7147 section_count++;
7148 }
7149 }
7150
7151 /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
7152 all of the sections we have selected. */
7153 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
7154 if (section_count != 0)
7155 amt += ((bfd_size_type) section_count - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
7156 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
7157 if (map == NULL)
7158 return FALSE;
7159
7160 /* Initialize the fields of the output segment map with the
7161 input segment. */
7162 map->next = NULL;
7163 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
7164 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
7165 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
7166 map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
7167 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
7168 map->p_align = segment->p_align;
7169 map->p_align_valid = 1;
7170 map->p_vaddr_offset = 0;
7171
7172 if (map->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO
7173 || map->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
7174 {
7175 /* The PT_GNU_RELRO segment may contain the first a few
7176 bytes in the .got.plt section even if the whole .got.plt
7177 section isn't in the PT_GNU_RELRO segment. We won't
7178 change the size of the PT_GNU_RELRO segment.
7179 Similarly, PT_GNU_STACK size is significant on uclinux
7180 systems. */
7181 map->p_size = segment->p_memsz;
7182 map->p_size_valid = 1;
7183 }
7184
7185 /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
7186 and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
7187 map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
7188 && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
7189
7190 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
7191 if (! phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
7192 {
7193 map->includes_phdrs =
7194 (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
7195 && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
7196 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
7197 + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
7198
7199 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
7200 phdr_included = TRUE;
7201 }
7202
7203 lowest_section = NULL;
7204 if (section_count != 0)
7205 {
7206 unsigned int isec = 0;
7207
7208 for (section = first_section;
7209 section != NULL;
7210 section = section->next)
7211 {
7212 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7213 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7214 {
7215 map->sections[isec++] = section->output_section;
7216 if ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
7217 {
7218 bfd_vma seg_off;
7219
7220 if (lowest_section == NULL
7221 || section->lma < lowest_section->lma)
7222 lowest_section = section;
7223
7224 /* Section lmas are set up from PT_LOAD header
7225 p_paddr in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr.
7226 If this header has a p_paddr that disagrees
7227 with the section lma, flag the p_paddr as
7228 invalid. */
7229 if ((section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
7230 seg_off = this_hdr->sh_offset - segment->p_offset;
7231 else
7232 seg_off = this_hdr->sh_addr - segment->p_vaddr;
7233 if (section->lma - segment->p_paddr != seg_off)
7234 map->p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
7235 }
7236 if (isec == section_count)
7237 break;
7238 }
7239 }
7240 }
7241
7242 if (map->includes_filehdr && lowest_section != NULL)
7243 /* We need to keep the space used by the headers fixed. */
7244 map->header_size = lowest_section->vma - segment->p_vaddr;
7245
7246 if (!map->includes_phdrs
7247 && !map->includes_filehdr
7248 && map->p_paddr_valid)
7249 /* There is some other padding before the first section. */
7250 map->p_vaddr_offset = ((lowest_section ? lowest_section->lma : 0)
7251 - segment->p_paddr);
7252
7253 map->count = section_count;
7254 *pointer_to_map = map;
7255 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7256 }
7257
7258 elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
7259 return TRUE;
7260 }
7261
7262 /* Copy private BFD data. This copies or rewrites ELF program header
7263 information. */
7264
7265 static bfd_boolean
7266 copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7267 {
7268 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7269 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7270 return TRUE;
7271
7272 if (elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr == NULL)
7273 return TRUE;
7274
7275 if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
7276 {
7277 /* Check to see if any sections in the input BFD
7278 covered by ELF program header have changed. */
7279 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7280 asection *section, *osec;
7281 unsigned int i, num_segments;
7282 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
7283 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7284
7285 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
7286
7287 /* Regenerate the segment map if p_paddr is set to 0. */
7288 if (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero)
7289 goto rewrite;
7290
7291 /* Initialize the segment mark field. */
7292 for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
7293 section = section->next)
7294 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
7295
7296 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7297 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7298 i < num_segments;
7299 i++, segment++)
7300 {
7301 /* PR binutils/3535. The Solaris linker always sets the p_paddr
7302 and p_memsz fields of special segments (DYNAMIC, INTERP) to 0
7303 which severly confuses things, so always regenerate the segment
7304 map in this case. */
7305 if (segment->p_paddr == 0
7306 && segment->p_memsz == 0
7307 && (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP || segment->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC))
7308 goto rewrite;
7309
7310 for (section = ibfd->sections;
7311 section != NULL; section = section->next)
7312 {
7313 /* We mark the output section so that we know it comes
7314 from the input BFD. */
7315 osec = section->output_section;
7316 if (osec)
7317 osec->segment_mark = TRUE;
7318
7319 /* Check if this section is covered by the segment. */
7320 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7321 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7322 {
7323 /* FIXME: Check if its output section is changed or
7324 removed. What else do we need to check? */
7325 if (osec == NULL
7326 || section->flags != osec->flags
7327 || section->lma != osec->lma
7328 || section->vma != osec->vma
7329 || section->size != osec->size
7330 || section->rawsize != osec->rawsize
7331 || section->alignment_power != osec->alignment_power)
7332 goto rewrite;
7333 }
7334 }
7335 }
7336
7337 /* Check to see if any output section do not come from the
7338 input BFD. */
7339 for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
7340 section = section->next)
7341 {
7342 if (section->segment_mark == FALSE)
7343 goto rewrite;
7344 else
7345 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
7346 }
7347
7348 return copy_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
7349 }
7350
7351 rewrite:
7352 if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
7353 {
7354 /* When rewriting program header, set the output maxpagesize to
7355 the maximum alignment of input PT_LOAD segments. */
7356 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7357 unsigned int i;
7358 unsigned int num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7359 bfd_vma maxpagesize = 0;
7360
7361 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7362 i < num_segments;
7363 i++, segment++)
7364 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD
7365 && maxpagesize < segment->p_align)
7366 {
7367 /* PR 17512: file: f17299af. */
7368 if (segment->p_align > (bfd_vma) 1 << ((sizeof (bfd_vma) * 8) - 2))
7369 /* xgettext:c-format */
7370 _bfd_error_handler (_("\
7371 %B: warning: segment alignment of 0x%llx is too large"),
7372 ibfd, (long long) segment->p_align);
7373 else
7374 maxpagesize = segment->p_align;
7375 }
7376
7377 if (maxpagesize != get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize)
7378 bfd_emul_set_maxpagesize (bfd_get_target (obfd), maxpagesize);
7379 }
7380
7381 return rewrite_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
7382 }
7383
7384 /* Initialize private output section information from input section. */
7385
7386 bfd_boolean
7387 _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
7388 asection *isec,
7389 bfd *obfd,
7390 asection *osec,
7391 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
7392
7393 {
7394 Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
7395 bfd_boolean final_link = (link_info != NULL
7396 && !bfd_link_relocatable (link_info));
7397
7398 if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7399 || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7400 return TRUE;
7401
7402 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (osec) != NULL);
7403
7404 /* For objcopy and relocatable link, don't copy the output ELF
7405 section type from input if the output BFD section flags have been
7406 set to something different. For a final link allow some flags
7407 that the linker clears to differ. */
7408 if (elf_section_type (osec) == SHT_NULL
7409 && (osec->flags == isec->flags
7410 || (final_link
7411 && ((osec->flags ^ isec->flags)
7412 & ~(SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES | SEC_RELOC)) == 0)))
7413 elf_section_type (osec) = elf_section_type (isec);
7414
7415 /* FIXME: Is this correct for all OS/PROC specific flags? */
7416 elf_section_flags (osec) |= (elf_section_flags (isec)
7417 & (SHF_MASKOS | SHF_MASKPROC));
7418
7419 /* Copy sh_info from input for mbind section. */
7420 if (elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GNU_MBIND)
7421 elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr.sh_info
7422 = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.sh_info;
7423
7424 /* Set things up for objcopy and relocatable link. The output
7425 SHT_GROUP section will have its elf_next_in_group pointing back
7426 to the input group members. Ignore linker created group section.
7427 See elfNN_ia64_object_p in elfxx-ia64.c. */
7428 if (!final_link)
7429 {
7430 if (elf_sec_group (isec) == NULL
7431 || (elf_sec_group (isec)->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
7432 {
7433 if (elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GROUP)
7434 elf_section_flags (osec) |= SHF_GROUP;
7435 elf_next_in_group (osec) = elf_next_in_group (isec);
7436 elf_section_data (osec)->group = elf_section_data (isec)->group;
7437 }
7438
7439 /* If not decompress, preserve SHF_COMPRESSED. */
7440 if ((ibfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS) == 0)
7441 elf_section_flags (osec) |= (elf_section_flags (isec)
7442 & SHF_COMPRESSED);
7443 }
7444
7445 ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
7446
7447 /* We need to handle elf_linked_to_section for SHF_LINK_ORDER. We
7448 don't use the output section of the linked-to section since it
7449 may be NULL at this point. */
7450 if ((ihdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
7451 {
7452 ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
7453 ohdr->sh_flags |= SHF_LINK_ORDER;
7454 elf_linked_to_section (osec) = elf_linked_to_section (isec);
7455 }
7456
7457 osec->use_rela_p = isec->use_rela_p;
7458
7459 return TRUE;
7460 }
7461
7462 /* Copy private section information. This copies over the entsize
7463 field, and sometimes the info field. */
7464
7465 bfd_boolean
7466 _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
7467 asection *isec,
7468 bfd *obfd,
7469 asection *osec)
7470 {
7471 Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
7472
7473 if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7474 || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7475 return TRUE;
7476
7477 ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
7478 ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
7479
7480 ohdr->sh_entsize = ihdr->sh_entsize;
7481
7482 if (ihdr->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
7483 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM
7484 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verneed
7485 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verdef)
7486 ohdr->sh_info = ihdr->sh_info;
7487
7488 return _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (ibfd, isec, obfd, osec,
7489 NULL);
7490 }
7491
7492 /* Look at all the SHT_GROUP sections in IBFD, making any adjustments
7493 necessary if we are removing either the SHT_GROUP section or any of
7494 the group member sections. DISCARDED is the value that a section's
7495 output_section has if the section will be discarded, NULL when this
7496 function is called from objcopy, bfd_abs_section_ptr when called
7497 from the linker. */
7498
7499 bfd_boolean
7500 _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (bfd *ibfd, asection *discarded)
7501 {
7502 asection *isec;
7503
7504 for (isec = ibfd->sections; isec != NULL; isec = isec->next)
7505 if (elf_section_type (isec) == SHT_GROUP)
7506 {
7507 asection *first = elf_next_in_group (isec);
7508 asection *s = first;
7509 bfd_size_type removed = 0;
7510
7511 while (s != NULL)
7512 {
7513 /* If this member section is being output but the
7514 SHT_GROUP section is not, then clear the group info
7515 set up by _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data. */
7516 if (s->output_section != discarded
7517 && isec->output_section == discarded)
7518 {
7519 elf_section_flags (s->output_section) &= ~SHF_GROUP;
7520 elf_group_name (s->output_section) = NULL;
7521 }
7522 /* Conversely, if the member section is not being output
7523 but the SHT_GROUP section is, then adjust its size. */
7524 else if (s->output_section == discarded
7525 && isec->output_section != discarded)
7526 removed += 4;
7527 s = elf_next_in_group (s);
7528 if (s == first)
7529 break;
7530 }
7531 if (removed != 0)
7532 {
7533 if (discarded != NULL)
7534 {
7535 /* If we've been called for ld -r, then we need to
7536 adjust the input section size. This function may
7537 be called multiple times, so save the original
7538 size. */
7539 if (isec->rawsize == 0)
7540 isec->rawsize = isec->size;
7541 isec->size = isec->rawsize - removed;
7542 }
7543 else
7544 {
7545 /* Adjust the output section size when called from
7546 objcopy. */
7547 isec->output_section->size -= removed;
7548 }
7549 }
7550 }
7551
7552 return TRUE;
7553 }
7554
7555 /* Copy private header information. */
7556
7557 bfd_boolean
7558 _bfd_elf_copy_private_header_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7559 {
7560 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7561 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7562 return TRUE;
7563
7564 /* Copy over private BFD data if it has not already been copied.
7565 This must be done here, rather than in the copy_private_bfd_data
7566 entry point, because the latter is called after the section
7567 contents have been set, which means that the program headers have
7568 already been worked out. */
7569 if (elf_seg_map (obfd) == NULL && elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr != NULL)
7570 {
7571 if (! copy_private_bfd_data (ibfd, obfd))
7572 return FALSE;
7573 }
7574
7575 return _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (ibfd, NULL);
7576 }
7577
7578 /* Copy private symbol information. If this symbol is in a section
7579 which we did not map into a BFD section, try to map the section
7580 index correctly. We use special macro definitions for the mapped
7581 section indices; these definitions are interpreted by the
7582 swap_out_syms function. */
7583
7584 #define MAP_ONESYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 1)
7585 #define MAP_DYNSYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 2)
7586 #define MAP_STRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 3)
7587 #define MAP_SHSTRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 4)
7588 #define MAP_SYM_SHNDX (SHN_HIOS + 5)
7589
7590 bfd_boolean
7591 _bfd_elf_copy_private_symbol_data (bfd *ibfd,
7592 asymbol *isymarg,
7593 bfd *obfd,
7594 asymbol *osymarg)
7595 {
7596 elf_symbol_type *isym, *osym;
7597
7598 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7599 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7600 return TRUE;
7601
7602 isym = elf_symbol_from (ibfd, isymarg);
7603 osym = elf_symbol_from (obfd, osymarg);
7604
7605 if (isym != NULL
7606 && isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
7607 && osym != NULL
7608 && bfd_is_abs_section (isym->symbol.section))
7609 {
7610 unsigned int shndx;
7611
7612 shndx = isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
7613 if (shndx == elf_onesymtab (ibfd))
7614 shndx = MAP_ONESYMTAB;
7615 else if (shndx == elf_dynsymtab (ibfd))
7616 shndx = MAP_DYNSYMTAB;
7617 else if (shndx == elf_strtab_sec (ibfd))
7618 shndx = MAP_STRTAB;
7619 else if (shndx == elf_shstrtab_sec (ibfd))
7620 shndx = MAP_SHSTRTAB;
7621 else if (find_section_in_list (shndx, elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd)))
7622 shndx = MAP_SYM_SHNDX;
7623 osym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx = shndx;
7624 }
7625
7626 return TRUE;
7627 }
7628
7629 /* Swap out the symbols. */
7630
7631 static bfd_boolean
7632 swap_out_syms (bfd *abfd,
7633 struct elf_strtab_hash **sttp,
7634 int relocatable_p)
7635 {
7636 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7637 int symcount;
7638 asymbol **syms;
7639 struct elf_strtab_hash *stt;
7640 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7641 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_shndx_hdr;
7642 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symstrtab_hdr;
7643 struct elf_sym_strtab *symstrtab;
7644 bfd_byte *outbound_syms;
7645 bfd_byte *outbound_shndx;
7646 unsigned long outbound_syms_index;
7647 unsigned long outbound_shndx_index;
7648 int idx;
7649 unsigned int num_locals;
7650 bfd_size_type amt;
7651 bfd_boolean name_local_sections;
7652
7653 if (!elf_map_symbols (abfd, &num_locals))
7654 return FALSE;
7655
7656 /* Dump out the symtabs. */
7657 stt = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
7658 if (stt == NULL)
7659 return FALSE;
7660
7661 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
7662 symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
7663 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
7664 symtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB;
7665 symtab_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
7666 symtab_hdr->sh_size = symtab_hdr->sh_entsize * (symcount + 1);
7667 symtab_hdr->sh_info = num_locals + 1;
7668 symtab_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
7669
7670 symstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
7671 symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
7672
7673 /* Allocate buffer to swap out the .strtab section. */
7674 symstrtab = (struct elf_sym_strtab *) bfd_malloc ((symcount + 1)
7675 * sizeof (*symstrtab));
7676 if (symstrtab == NULL)
7677 {
7678 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt);
7679 return FALSE;
7680 }
7681
7682 outbound_syms = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount,
7683 bed->s->sizeof_sym);
7684 if (outbound_syms == NULL)
7685 {
7686 error_return:
7687 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt);
7688 free (symstrtab);
7689 return FALSE;
7690 }
7691 symtab_hdr->contents = outbound_syms;
7692 outbound_syms_index = 0;
7693
7694 outbound_shndx = NULL;
7695 outbound_shndx_index = 0;
7696
7697 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd))
7698 {
7699 symtab_shndx_hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->hdr;
7700 if (symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_name != 0)
7701 {
7702 amt = (bfd_size_type) (1 + symcount) * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
7703 outbound_shndx = (bfd_byte *)
7704 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, 1 + symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx));
7705 if (outbound_shndx == NULL)
7706 goto error_return;
7707
7708 symtab_shndx_hdr->contents = outbound_shndx;
7709 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX;
7710 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_size = amt;
7711 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_addralign = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
7712 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
7713 }
7714 /* FIXME: What about any other headers in the list ? */
7715 }
7716
7717 /* Now generate the data (for "contents"). */
7718 {
7719 /* Fill in zeroth symbol and swap it out. */
7720 Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
7721 sym.st_name = 0;
7722 sym.st_value = 0;
7723 sym.st_size = 0;
7724 sym.st_info = 0;
7725 sym.st_other = 0;
7726 sym.st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
7727 sym.st_target_internal = 0;
7728 symstrtab[0].sym = sym;
7729 symstrtab[0].dest_index = outbound_syms_index;
7730 symstrtab[0].destshndx_index = outbound_shndx_index;
7731 outbound_syms_index++;
7732 if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
7733 outbound_shndx_index++;
7734 }
7735
7736 name_local_sections
7737 = (bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols
7738 && bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols (abfd));
7739
7740 syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
7741 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount;)
7742 {
7743 Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
7744 bfd_vma value = syms[idx]->value;
7745 elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
7746 flagword flags = syms[idx]->flags;
7747 int type;
7748
7749 if (!name_local_sections
7750 && (flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_GLOBAL)) == BSF_SECTION_SYM)
7751 {
7752 /* Local section symbols have no name. */
7753 sym.st_name = (unsigned long) -1;
7754 }
7755 else
7756 {
7757 /* Call _bfd_elf_strtab_offset after _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize
7758 to get the final offset for st_name. */
7759 sym.st_name
7760 = (unsigned long) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (stt, syms[idx]->name,
7761 FALSE);
7762 if (sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
7763 goto error_return;
7764 }
7765
7766 type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, syms[idx]);
7767
7768 if ((flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
7769 && bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
7770 {
7771 /* ELF common symbols put the alignment into the `value' field,
7772 and the size into the `size' field. This is backwards from
7773 how BFD handles it, so reverse it here. */
7774 sym.st_size = value;
7775 if (type_ptr == NULL
7776 || type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value == 0)
7777 sym.st_value = value >= 16 ? 16 : (1 << bfd_log2 (value));
7778 else
7779 sym.st_value = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
7780 sym.st_shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
7781 (abfd, syms[idx]->section);
7782 }
7783 else
7784 {
7785 asection *sec = syms[idx]->section;
7786 unsigned int shndx;
7787
7788 if (sec->output_section)
7789 {
7790 value += sec->output_offset;
7791 sec = sec->output_section;
7792 }
7793
7794 /* Don't add in the section vma for relocatable output. */
7795 if (! relocatable_p)
7796 value += sec->vma;
7797 sym.st_value = value;
7798 sym.st_size = type_ptr ? type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_size : 0;
7799
7800 if (bfd_is_abs_section (sec)
7801 && type_ptr != NULL
7802 && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0)
7803 {
7804 /* This symbol is in a real ELF section which we did
7805 not create as a BFD section. Undo the mapping done
7806 by copy_private_symbol_data. */
7807 shndx = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
7808 switch (shndx)
7809 {
7810 case MAP_ONESYMTAB:
7811 shndx = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
7812 break;
7813 case MAP_DYNSYMTAB:
7814 shndx = elf_dynsymtab (abfd);
7815 break;
7816 case MAP_STRTAB:
7817 shndx = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
7818 break;
7819 case MAP_SHSTRTAB:
7820 shndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
7821 break;
7822 case MAP_SYM_SHNDX:
7823 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd))
7824 shndx = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx;
7825 break;
7826 default:
7827 shndx = SHN_ABS;
7828 break;
7829 }
7830 }
7831 else
7832 {
7833 shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec);
7834
7835 if (shndx == SHN_BAD)
7836 {
7837 asection *sec2;
7838
7839 /* Writing this would be a hell of a lot easier if
7840 we had some decent documentation on bfd, and
7841 knew what to expect of the library, and what to
7842 demand of applications. For example, it
7843 appears that `objcopy' might not set the
7844 section of a symbol to be a section that is
7845 actually in the output file. */
7846 sec2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec->name);
7847 if (sec2 != NULL)
7848 shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec2);
7849 if (shndx == SHN_BAD)
7850 {
7851 /* xgettext:c-format */
7852 _bfd_error_handler (_("\
7853 Unable to find equivalent output section for symbol '%s' from section '%s'"),
7854 syms[idx]->name ? syms[idx]->name : "<Local sym>",
7855 sec->name);
7856 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
7857 goto error_return;
7858 }
7859 }
7860 }
7861
7862 sym.st_shndx = shndx;
7863 }
7864
7865 if ((flags & BSF_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
7866 type = STT_TLS;
7867 else if ((flags & BSF_GNU_INDIRECT_FUNCTION) != 0)
7868 type = STT_GNU_IFUNC;
7869 else if ((flags & BSF_FUNCTION) != 0)
7870 type = STT_FUNC;
7871 else if ((flags & BSF_OBJECT) != 0)
7872 type = STT_OBJECT;
7873 else if ((flags & BSF_RELC) != 0)
7874 type = STT_RELC;
7875 else if ((flags & BSF_SRELC) != 0)
7876 type = STT_SRELC;
7877 else
7878 type = STT_NOTYPE;
7879
7880 if (syms[idx]->section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
7881 type = STT_TLS;
7882
7883 /* Processor-specific types. */
7884 if (type_ptr != NULL
7885 && bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
7886 type = ((*bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
7887 (&type_ptr->internal_elf_sym, type));
7888
7889 if (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
7890 {
7891 if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
7892 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
7893 else
7894 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_SECTION);
7895 }
7896 else if (bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
7897 {
7898 if (type != STT_TLS)
7899 {
7900 if ((abfd->flags & BFD_CONVERT_ELF_COMMON))
7901 type = ((abfd->flags & BFD_USE_ELF_STT_COMMON)
7902 ? STT_COMMON : STT_OBJECT);
7903 else
7904 type = ((flags & BSF_ELF_COMMON) != 0
7905 ? STT_COMMON : STT_OBJECT);
7906 }
7907 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, type);
7908 }
7909 else if (bfd_is_und_section (syms[idx]->section))
7910 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (((flags & BSF_WEAK)
7911 ? STB_WEAK
7912 : STB_GLOBAL),
7913 type);
7914 else if (flags & BSF_FILE)
7915 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_FILE);
7916 else
7917 {
7918 int bind = STB_LOCAL;
7919
7920 if (flags & BSF_LOCAL)
7921 bind = STB_LOCAL;
7922 else if (flags & BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)
7923 bind = STB_GNU_UNIQUE;
7924 else if (flags & BSF_WEAK)
7925 bind = STB_WEAK;
7926 else if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
7927 bind = STB_GLOBAL;
7928
7929 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (bind, type);
7930 }
7931
7932 if (type_ptr != NULL)
7933 {
7934 sym.st_other = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
7935 sym.st_target_internal
7936 = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_target_internal;
7937 }
7938 else
7939 {
7940 sym.st_other = 0;
7941 sym.st_target_internal = 0;
7942 }
7943
7944 idx++;
7945 symstrtab[idx].sym = sym;
7946 symstrtab[idx].dest_index = outbound_syms_index;
7947 symstrtab[idx].destshndx_index = outbound_shndx_index;
7948
7949 outbound_syms_index++;
7950 if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
7951 outbound_shndx_index++;
7952 }
7953
7954 /* Finalize the .strtab section. */
7955 _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (stt);
7956
7957 /* Swap out the .strtab section. */
7958 for (idx = 0; idx <= symcount; idx++)
7959 {
7960 struct elf_sym_strtab *elfsym = &symstrtab[idx];
7961 if (elfsym->sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
7962 elfsym->sym.st_name = 0;
7963 else
7964 elfsym->sym.st_name = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (stt,
7965 elfsym->sym.st_name);
7966 bed->s->swap_symbol_out (abfd, &elfsym->sym,
7967 (outbound_syms
7968 + (elfsym->dest_index
7969 * bed->s->sizeof_sym)),
7970 (outbound_shndx
7971 + (elfsym->destshndx_index
7972 * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx))));
7973 }
7974 free (symstrtab);
7975
7976 *sttp = stt;
7977 symstrtab_hdr->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (stt);
7978 symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
7979 symstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = bed->elf_strtab_flags;
7980 symstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
7981 symstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
7982 symstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
7983 symstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
7984 symstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
7985
7986 return TRUE;
7987 }
7988
7989 /* Return the number of bytes required to hold the symtab vector.
7990
7991 Note that we base it on the count plus 1, since we will null terminate
7992 the vector allocated based on this size. However, the ELF symbol table
7993 always has a dummy entry as symbol #0, so it ends up even. */
7994
7995 long
7996 _bfd_elf_get_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
7997 {
7998 long symcount;
7999 long symtab_size;
8000 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
8001
8002 symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
8003 symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
8004 if (symcount > 0)
8005 symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
8006
8007 return symtab_size;
8008 }
8009
8010 long
8011 _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8012 {
8013 long symcount;
8014 long symtab_size;
8015 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
8016
8017 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8018 {
8019 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8020 return -1;
8021 }
8022
8023 symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
8024 symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
8025 if (symcount > 0)
8026 symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
8027
8028 return symtab_size;
8029 }
8030
8031 long
8032 _bfd_elf_get_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8033 sec_ptr asect)
8034 {
8035 return (asect->reloc_count + 1) * sizeof (arelent *);
8036 }
8037
8038 /* Canonicalize the relocs. */
8039
8040 long
8041 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_reloc (bfd *abfd,
8042 sec_ptr section,
8043 arelent **relptr,
8044 asymbol **symbols)
8045 {
8046 arelent *tblptr;
8047 unsigned int i;
8048 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8049
8050 if (! bed->s->slurp_reloc_table (abfd, section, symbols, FALSE))
8051 return -1;
8052
8053 tblptr = section->relocation;
8054 for (i = 0; i < section->reloc_count; i++)
8055 *relptr++ = tblptr++;
8056
8057 *relptr = NULL;
8058
8059 return section->reloc_count;
8060 }
8061
8062 long
8063 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_symtab (bfd *abfd, asymbol **allocation)
8064 {
8065 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8066 long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, FALSE);
8067
8068 if (symcount >= 0)
8069 bfd_get_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
8070 return symcount;
8071 }
8072
8073 long
8074 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
8075 asymbol **allocation)
8076 {
8077 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8078 long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, TRUE);
8079
8080 if (symcount >= 0)
8081 bfd_get_dynamic_symcount (abfd) = symcount;
8082 return symcount;
8083 }
8084
8085 /* Return the size required for the dynamic reloc entries. Any loadable
8086 section that was actually installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL
8087 or SHT_RELA, and uses the dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a
8088 dynamic reloc section. */
8089
8090 long
8091 _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8092 {
8093 long ret;
8094 asection *s;
8095
8096 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8097 {
8098 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8099 return -1;
8100 }
8101
8102 ret = sizeof (arelent *);
8103 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
8104 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
8105 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
8106 || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
8107 ret += ((s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize)
8108 * sizeof (arelent *));
8109
8110 return ret;
8111 }
8112
8113 /* Canonicalize the dynamic relocation entries. Note that we return the
8114 dynamic relocations as a single block, although they are actually
8115 associated with particular sections; the interface, which was
8116 designed for SunOS style shared libraries, expects that there is only
8117 one set of dynamic relocs. Any loadable section that was actually
8118 installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL or SHT_RELA, and uses the
8119 dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a dynamic reloc section. */
8120
8121 long
8122 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_reloc (bfd *abfd,
8123 arelent **storage,
8124 asymbol **syms)
8125 {
8126 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
8127 asection *s;
8128 long ret;
8129
8130 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8131 {
8132 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8133 return -1;
8134 }
8135
8136 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
8137 ret = 0;
8138 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
8139 {
8140 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
8141 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
8142 || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
8143 {
8144 arelent *p;
8145 long count, i;
8146
8147 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, s, syms, TRUE))
8148 return -1;
8149 count = s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize;
8150 p = s->relocation;
8151 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
8152 *storage++ = p++;
8153 ret += count;
8154 }
8155 }
8156
8157 *storage = NULL;
8158
8159 return ret;
8160 }
8161 \f
8162 /* Read in the version information. */
8163
8164 bfd_boolean
8165 _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean default_imported_symver)
8166 {
8167 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
8168 unsigned int freeidx = 0;
8169
8170 if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
8171 {
8172 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8173 Elf_External_Verneed *everneed;
8174 Elf_Internal_Verneed *iverneed;
8175 unsigned int i;
8176 bfd_byte *contents_end;
8177
8178 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr;
8179
8180 if (hdr->sh_info == 0 || hdr->sh_size < sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed))
8181 {
8182 error_return_bad_verref:
8183 _bfd_error_handler
8184 (_("%B: .gnu.version_r invalid entry"), abfd);
8185 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8186 error_return_verref:
8187 elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = NULL;
8188 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = 0;
8189 goto error_return;
8190 }
8191
8192 contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
8193 if (contents == NULL)
8194 goto error_return_verref;
8195
8196 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
8197 || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
8198 goto error_return_verref;
8199
8200 elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = (Elf_Internal_Verneed *)
8201 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, hdr->sh_info, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verneed));
8202
8203 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL)
8204 goto error_return_verref;
8205
8206 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed)
8207 == sizeof (Elf_External_Vernaux));
8208 contents_end = contents + hdr->sh_size - sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed);
8209 everneed = (Elf_External_Verneed *) contents;
8210 iverneed = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
8211 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++, iverneed++)
8212 {
8213 Elf_External_Vernaux *evernaux;
8214 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *ivernaux;
8215 unsigned int j;
8216
8217 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (abfd, everneed, iverneed);
8218
8219 iverneed->vn_bfd = abfd;
8220
8221 iverneed->vn_filename =
8222 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8223 iverneed->vn_file);
8224 if (iverneed->vn_filename == NULL)
8225 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8226
8227 if (iverneed->vn_cnt == 0)
8228 iverneed->vn_auxptr = NULL;
8229 else
8230 {
8231 iverneed->vn_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_vernaux *)
8232 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverneed->vn_cnt,
8233 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Vernaux));
8234 if (iverneed->vn_auxptr == NULL)
8235 goto error_return_verref;
8236 }
8237
8238 if (iverneed->vn_aux
8239 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
8240 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8241
8242 evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
8243 ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_aux));
8244 ivernaux = iverneed->vn_auxptr;
8245 for (j = 0; j < iverneed->vn_cnt; j++, ivernaux++)
8246 {
8247 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (abfd, evernaux, ivernaux);
8248
8249 ivernaux->vna_nodename =
8250 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8251 ivernaux->vna_name);
8252 if (ivernaux->vna_nodename == NULL)
8253 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8254
8255 if (ivernaux->vna_other > freeidx)
8256 freeidx = ivernaux->vna_other;
8257
8258 ivernaux->vna_nextptr = NULL;
8259 if (ivernaux->vna_next == 0)
8260 {
8261 iverneed->vn_cnt = j + 1;
8262 break;
8263 }
8264 if (j + 1 < iverneed->vn_cnt)
8265 ivernaux->vna_nextptr = ivernaux + 1;
8266
8267 if (ivernaux->vna_next
8268 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) evernaux))
8269 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8270
8271 evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
8272 ((bfd_byte *) evernaux + ivernaux->vna_next));
8273 }
8274
8275 iverneed->vn_nextref = NULL;
8276 if (iverneed->vn_next == 0)
8277 break;
8278 if (i + 1 < hdr->sh_info)
8279 iverneed->vn_nextref = iverneed + 1;
8280
8281 if (iverneed->vn_next
8282 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
8283 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8284
8285 everneed = ((Elf_External_Verneed *)
8286 ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_next));
8287 }
8288 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = i;
8289
8290 free (contents);
8291 contents = NULL;
8292 }
8293
8294 if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
8295 {
8296 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8297 Elf_External_Verdef *everdef;
8298 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
8299 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdefarr;
8300 Elf_Internal_Verdef iverdefmem;
8301 unsigned int i;
8302 unsigned int maxidx;
8303 bfd_byte *contents_end_def, *contents_end_aux;
8304
8305 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr;
8306
8307 if (hdr->sh_info == 0 || hdr->sh_size < sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef))
8308 {
8309 error_return_bad_verdef:
8310 _bfd_error_handler
8311 (_("%B: .gnu.version_d invalid entry"), abfd);
8312 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8313 error_return_verdef:
8314 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = NULL;
8315 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = 0;
8316 goto error_return;
8317 }
8318
8319 contents = (bfd_byte *) bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
8320 if (contents == NULL)
8321 goto error_return_verdef;
8322 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
8323 || bfd_bread (contents, hdr->sh_size, abfd) != hdr->sh_size)
8324 goto error_return_verdef;
8325
8326 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef)
8327 >= sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux));
8328 contents_end_def = contents + hdr->sh_size
8329 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef);
8330 contents_end_aux = contents + hdr->sh_size
8331 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux);
8332
8333 /* We know the number of entries in the section but not the maximum
8334 index. Therefore we have to run through all entries and find
8335 the maximum. */
8336 everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
8337 maxidx = 0;
8338 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; ++i)
8339 {
8340 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
8341
8342 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) == 0)
8343 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8344 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) > maxidx)
8345 maxidx = iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION);
8346
8347 if (iverdefmem.vd_next == 0)
8348 break;
8349
8350 if (iverdefmem.vd_next
8351 > (size_t) (contents_end_def - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
8352 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8353
8354 everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
8355 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdefmem.vd_next));
8356 }
8357
8358 if (default_imported_symver)
8359 {
8360 if (freeidx > maxidx)
8361 maxidx = ++freeidx;
8362 else
8363 freeidx = ++maxidx;
8364 }
8365
8366 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *)
8367 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, maxidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
8368 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
8369 goto error_return_verdef;
8370
8371 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = maxidx;
8372
8373 everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
8374 iverdefarr = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef;
8375 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++)
8376 {
8377 Elf_External_Verdaux *everdaux;
8378 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
8379 unsigned int j;
8380
8381 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
8382
8383 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) == 0)
8384 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8385
8386 iverdef = &iverdefarr[(iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) - 1];
8387 memcpy (iverdef, &iverdefmem, offsetof (Elf_Internal_Verdef, vd_bfd));
8388
8389 iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
8390
8391 if (iverdef->vd_cnt == 0)
8392 iverdef->vd_auxptr = NULL;
8393 else
8394 {
8395 iverdef->vd_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
8396 bfd_alloc2 (abfd, iverdef->vd_cnt,
8397 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux));
8398 if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
8399 goto error_return_verdef;
8400 }
8401
8402 if (iverdef->vd_aux
8403 > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
8404 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8405
8406 everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
8407 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_aux));
8408 iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
8409 for (j = 0; j < iverdef->vd_cnt; j++, iverdaux++)
8410 {
8411 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (abfd, everdaux, iverdaux);
8412
8413 iverdaux->vda_nodename =
8414 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8415 iverdaux->vda_name);
8416 if (iverdaux->vda_nodename == NULL)
8417 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8418
8419 iverdaux->vda_nextptr = NULL;
8420 if (iverdaux->vda_next == 0)
8421 {
8422 iverdef->vd_cnt = j + 1;
8423 break;
8424 }
8425 if (j + 1 < iverdef->vd_cnt)
8426 iverdaux->vda_nextptr = iverdaux + 1;
8427
8428 if (iverdaux->vda_next
8429 > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdaux))
8430 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8431
8432 everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
8433 ((bfd_byte *) everdaux + iverdaux->vda_next));
8434 }
8435
8436 iverdef->vd_nodename = NULL;
8437 if (iverdef->vd_cnt)
8438 iverdef->vd_nodename = iverdef->vd_auxptr->vda_nodename;
8439
8440 iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
8441 if (iverdef->vd_next == 0)
8442 break;
8443 if ((size_t) (iverdef - iverdefarr) + 1 < maxidx)
8444 iverdef->vd_nextdef = iverdef + 1;
8445
8446 everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
8447 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_next));
8448 }
8449
8450 free (contents);
8451 contents = NULL;
8452 }
8453 else if (default_imported_symver)
8454 {
8455 if (freeidx < 3)
8456 freeidx = 3;
8457 else
8458 freeidx++;
8459
8460 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *)
8461 bfd_zalloc2 (abfd, freeidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef));
8462 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
8463 goto error_return;
8464
8465 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = freeidx;
8466 }
8467
8468 /* Create a default version based on the soname. */
8469 if (default_imported_symver)
8470 {
8471 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
8472 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
8473
8474 iverdef = &elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[freeidx - 1];
8475
8476 iverdef->vd_version = VER_DEF_CURRENT;
8477 iverdef->vd_flags = 0;
8478 iverdef->vd_ndx = freeidx;
8479 iverdef->vd_cnt = 1;
8480
8481 iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
8482
8483 iverdef->vd_nodename = bfd_elf_get_dt_soname (abfd);
8484 if (iverdef->vd_nodename == NULL)
8485 goto error_return_verdef;
8486 iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
8487 iverdef->vd_auxptr = ((struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
8488 bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux)));
8489 if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
8490 goto error_return_verdef;
8491
8492 iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
8493 iverdaux->vda_nodename = iverdef->vd_nodename;
8494 }
8495
8496 return TRUE;
8497
8498 error_return:
8499 if (contents != NULL)
8500 free (contents);
8501 return FALSE;
8502 }
8503 \f
8504 asymbol *
8505 _bfd_elf_make_empty_symbol (bfd *abfd)
8506 {
8507 elf_symbol_type *newsym;
8508
8509 newsym = (elf_symbol_type *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof * newsym);
8510 if (!newsym)
8511 return NULL;
8512 newsym->symbol.the_bfd = abfd;
8513 return &newsym->symbol;
8514 }
8515
8516 void
8517 _bfd_elf_get_symbol_info (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8518 asymbol *symbol,
8519 symbol_info *ret)
8520 {
8521 bfd_symbol_info (symbol, ret);
8522 }
8523
8524 /* Return whether a symbol name implies a local symbol. Most targets
8525 use this function for the is_local_label_name entry point, but some
8526 override it. */
8527
8528 bfd_boolean
8529 _bfd_elf_is_local_label_name (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8530 const char *name)
8531 {
8532 /* Normal local symbols start with ``.L''. */
8533 if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == 'L')
8534 return TRUE;
8535
8536 /* At least some SVR4 compilers (e.g., UnixWare 2.1 cc) generate
8537 DWARF debugging symbols starting with ``..''. */
8538 if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == '.')
8539 return TRUE;
8540
8541 /* gcc will sometimes generate symbols beginning with ``_.L_'' when
8542 emitting DWARF debugging output. I suspect this is actually a
8543 small bug in gcc (it calls ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL when it should call
8544 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL, and this causes the leading
8545 underscore to be emitted on some ELF targets). For ease of use,
8546 we treat such symbols as local. */
8547 if (name[0] == '_' && name[1] == '.' && name[2] == 'L' && name[3] == '_')
8548 return TRUE;
8549
8550 /* Treat assembler generated fake symbols, dollar local labels and
8551 forward-backward labels (aka local labels) as locals.
8552 These labels have the form:
8553
8554 L0^A.* (fake symbols)
8555
8556 [.]?L[0123456789]+{^A|^B}[0123456789]* (local labels)
8557
8558 Versions which start with .L will have already been matched above,
8559 so we only need to match the rest. */
8560 if (name[0] == 'L' && ISDIGIT (name[1]))
8561 {
8562 bfd_boolean ret = FALSE;
8563 const char * p;
8564 char c;
8565
8566 for (p = name + 2; (c = *p); p++)
8567 {
8568 if (c == 1 || c == 2)
8569 {
8570 if (c == 1 && p == name + 2)
8571 /* A fake symbol. */
8572 return TRUE;
8573
8574 /* FIXME: We are being paranoid here and treating symbols like
8575 L0^Bfoo as if there were non-local, on the grounds that the
8576 assembler will never generate them. But can any symbol
8577 containing an ASCII value in the range 1-31 ever be anything
8578 other than some kind of local ? */
8579 ret = TRUE;
8580 }
8581
8582 if (! ISDIGIT (c))
8583 {
8584 ret = FALSE;
8585 break;
8586 }
8587 }
8588 return ret;
8589 }
8590
8591 return FALSE;
8592 }
8593
8594 alent *
8595 _bfd_elf_get_lineno (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8596 asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8597 {
8598 abort ();
8599 return NULL;
8600 }
8601
8602 bfd_boolean
8603 _bfd_elf_set_arch_mach (bfd *abfd,
8604 enum bfd_architecture arch,
8605 unsigned long machine)
8606 {
8607 /* If this isn't the right architecture for this backend, and this
8608 isn't the generic backend, fail. */
8609 if (arch != get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch
8610 && arch != bfd_arch_unknown
8611 && get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch != bfd_arch_unknown)
8612 return FALSE;
8613
8614 return bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd, arch, machine);
8615 }
8616
8617 /* Find the nearest line to a particular section and offset,
8618 for error reporting. */
8619
8620 bfd_boolean
8621 _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd,
8622 asymbol **symbols,
8623 asection *section,
8624 bfd_vma offset,
8625 const char **filename_ptr,
8626 const char **functionname_ptr,
8627 unsigned int *line_ptr,
8628 unsigned int *discriminator_ptr)
8629 {
8630 bfd_boolean found;
8631
8632 if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, NULL, section, offset,
8633 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
8634 line_ptr, discriminator_ptr,
8635 dwarf_debug_sections, 0,
8636 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info)
8637 || _bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8638 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
8639 line_ptr))
8640 {
8641 if (!*functionname_ptr)
8642 _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8643 *filename_ptr ? NULL : filename_ptr,
8644 functionname_ptr);
8645 return TRUE;
8646 }
8647
8648 if (! _bfd_stab_section_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8649 &found, filename_ptr,
8650 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
8651 &elf_tdata (abfd)->line_info))
8652 return FALSE;
8653 if (found && (*functionname_ptr || *line_ptr))
8654 return TRUE;
8655
8656 if (symbols == NULL)
8657 return FALSE;
8658
8659 if (! _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
8660 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr))
8661 return FALSE;
8662
8663 *line_ptr = 0;
8664 return TRUE;
8665 }
8666
8667 /* Find the line for a symbol. */
8668
8669 bfd_boolean
8670 _bfd_elf_find_line (bfd *abfd, asymbol **symbols, asymbol *symbol,
8671 const char **filename_ptr, unsigned int *line_ptr)
8672 {
8673 return _bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, symbol, NULL, 0,
8674 filename_ptr, NULL, line_ptr, NULL,
8675 dwarf_debug_sections, 0,
8676 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
8677 }
8678
8679 /* After a call to bfd_find_nearest_line, successive calls to
8680 bfd_find_inliner_info can be used to get source information about
8681 each level of function inlining that terminated at the address
8682 passed to bfd_find_nearest_line. Currently this is only supported
8683 for DWARF2 with appropriate DWARF3 extensions. */
8684
8685 bfd_boolean
8686 _bfd_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd *abfd,
8687 const char **filename_ptr,
8688 const char **functionname_ptr,
8689 unsigned int *line_ptr)
8690 {
8691 bfd_boolean found;
8692 found = _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd, filename_ptr,
8693 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
8694 & elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
8695 return found;
8696 }
8697
8698 int
8699 _bfd_elf_sizeof_headers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
8700 {
8701 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8702 int ret = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
8703
8704 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info))
8705 {
8706 bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
8707
8708 if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
8709 {
8710 struct elf_segment_map *m;
8711
8712 phdr_size = 0;
8713 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
8714 phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
8715
8716 if (phdr_size == 0)
8717 phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
8718 }
8719
8720 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = phdr_size;
8721 ret += phdr_size;
8722 }
8723
8724 return ret;
8725 }
8726
8727 bfd_boolean
8728 _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd,
8729 sec_ptr section,
8730 const void *location,
8731 file_ptr offset,
8732 bfd_size_type count)
8733 {
8734 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8735 file_ptr pos;
8736
8737 if (! abfd->output_has_begun
8738 && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
8739 return FALSE;
8740
8741 if (!count)
8742 return TRUE;
8743
8744 hdr = &elf_section_data (section)->this_hdr;
8745 if (hdr->sh_offset == (file_ptr) -1)
8746 {
8747 /* We must compress this section. Write output to the buffer. */
8748 unsigned char *contents = hdr->contents;
8749 if ((offset + count) > hdr->sh_size
8750 || (section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS) == 0
8751 || contents == NULL)
8752 abort ();
8753 memcpy (contents + offset, location, count);
8754 return TRUE;
8755 }
8756 pos = hdr->sh_offset + offset;
8757 if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
8758 || bfd_bwrite (location, count, abfd) != count)
8759 return FALSE;
8760
8761 return TRUE;
8762 }
8763
8764 void
8765 _bfd_elf_no_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8766 arelent *cache_ptr ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8767 Elf_Internal_Rela *dst ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8768 {
8769 abort ();
8770 }
8771
8772 /* Try to convert a non-ELF reloc into an ELF one. */
8773
8774 bfd_boolean
8775 _bfd_elf_validate_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *areloc)
8776 {
8777 /* Check whether we really have an ELF howto. */
8778
8779 if ((*areloc->sym_ptr_ptr)->the_bfd->xvec != abfd->xvec)
8780 {
8781 bfd_reloc_code_real_type code;
8782 reloc_howto_type *howto;
8783
8784 /* Alien reloc: Try to determine its type to replace it with an
8785 equivalent ELF reloc. */
8786
8787 if (areloc->howto->pc_relative)
8788 {
8789 switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
8790 {
8791 case 8:
8792 code = BFD_RELOC_8_PCREL;
8793 break;
8794 case 12:
8795 code = BFD_RELOC_12_PCREL;
8796 break;
8797 case 16:
8798 code = BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL;
8799 break;
8800 case 24:
8801 code = BFD_RELOC_24_PCREL;
8802 break;
8803 case 32:
8804 code = BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL;
8805 break;
8806 case 64:
8807 code = BFD_RELOC_64_PCREL;
8808 break;
8809 default:
8810 goto fail;
8811 }
8812
8813 howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
8814
8815 if (areloc->howto->pcrel_offset != howto->pcrel_offset)
8816 {
8817 if (howto->pcrel_offset)
8818 areloc->addend += areloc->address;
8819 else
8820 areloc->addend -= areloc->address; /* addend is unsigned!! */
8821 }
8822 }
8823 else
8824 {
8825 switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
8826 {
8827 case 8:
8828 code = BFD_RELOC_8;
8829 break;
8830 case 14:
8831 code = BFD_RELOC_14;
8832 break;
8833 case 16:
8834 code = BFD_RELOC_16;
8835 break;
8836 case 26:
8837 code = BFD_RELOC_26;
8838 break;
8839 case 32:
8840 code = BFD_RELOC_32;
8841 break;
8842 case 64:
8843 code = BFD_RELOC_64;
8844 break;
8845 default:
8846 goto fail;
8847 }
8848
8849 howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
8850 }
8851
8852 if (howto)
8853 areloc->howto = howto;
8854 else
8855 goto fail;
8856 }
8857
8858 return TRUE;
8859
8860 fail:
8861 _bfd_error_handler
8862 /* xgettext:c-format */
8863 (_("%B: unsupported relocation type %s"),
8864 abfd, areloc->howto->name);
8865 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8866 return FALSE;
8867 }
8868
8869 bfd_boolean
8870 _bfd_elf_close_and_cleanup (bfd *abfd)
8871 {
8872 struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
8873 if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_object && tdata != NULL)
8874 {
8875 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->o != NULL && elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL)
8876 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
8877 _bfd_dwarf2_cleanup_debug_info (abfd, &tdata->dwarf2_find_line_info);
8878 }
8879
8880 return _bfd_generic_close_and_cleanup (abfd);
8881 }
8882
8883 /* For Rel targets, we encode meaningful data for BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY
8884 in the relocation's offset. Thus we cannot allow any sort of sanity
8885 range-checking to interfere. There is nothing else to do in processing
8886 this reloc. */
8887
8888 bfd_reloc_status_type
8889 _bfd_elf_rel_vtable_reloc_fn
8890 (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *re ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8891 struct bfd_symbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8892 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *is ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8893 bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, char **errmsg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8894 {
8895 return bfd_reloc_ok;
8896 }
8897 \f
8898 /* Elf core file support. Much of this only works on native
8899 toolchains, since we rely on knowing the
8900 machine-dependent procfs structure in order to pick
8901 out details about the corefile. */
8902
8903 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_PROCFS_H
8904 /* Needed for new procfs interface on sparc-solaris. */
8905 # define _STRUCTURED_PROC 1
8906 # include <sys/procfs.h>
8907 #endif
8908
8909 /* Return a PID that identifies a "thread" for threaded cores, or the
8910 PID of the main process for non-threaded cores. */
8911
8912 static int
8913 elfcore_make_pid (bfd *abfd)
8914 {
8915 int pid;
8916
8917 pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid;
8918 if (pid == 0)
8919 pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid;
8920
8921 return pid;
8922 }
8923
8924 /* If there isn't a section called NAME, make one, using
8925 data from SECT. Note, this function will generate a
8926 reference to NAME, so you shouldn't deallocate or
8927 overwrite it. */
8928
8929 static bfd_boolean
8930 elfcore_maybe_make_sect (bfd *abfd, char *name, asection *sect)
8931 {
8932 asection *sect2;
8933
8934 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name) != NULL)
8935 return TRUE;
8936
8937 sect2 = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, name, sect->flags);
8938 if (sect2 == NULL)
8939 return FALSE;
8940
8941 sect2->size = sect->size;
8942 sect2->filepos = sect->filepos;
8943 sect2->alignment_power = sect->alignment_power;
8944 return TRUE;
8945 }
8946
8947 /* Create a pseudosection containing SIZE bytes at FILEPOS. This
8948 actually creates up to two pseudosections:
8949 - For the single-threaded case, a section named NAME, unless
8950 such a section already exists.
8951 - For the multi-threaded case, a section named "NAME/PID", where
8952 PID is elfcore_make_pid (abfd).
8953 Both pseudosections have identical contents. */
8954 bfd_boolean
8955 _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
8956 char *name,
8957 size_t size,
8958 ufile_ptr filepos)
8959 {
8960 char buf[100];
8961 char *threaded_name;
8962 size_t len;
8963 asection *sect;
8964
8965 /* Build the section name. */
8966
8967 sprintf (buf, "%s/%d", name, elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
8968 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
8969 threaded_name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
8970 if (threaded_name == NULL)
8971 return FALSE;
8972 memcpy (threaded_name, buf, len);
8973
8974 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, threaded_name,
8975 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
8976 if (sect == NULL)
8977 return FALSE;
8978 sect->size = size;
8979 sect->filepos = filepos;
8980 sect->alignment_power = 2;
8981
8982 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, name, sect);
8983 }
8984
8985 /* prstatus_t exists on:
8986 solaris 2.5+
8987 linux 2.[01] + glibc
8988 unixware 4.2
8989 */
8990
8991 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
8992
8993 static bfd_boolean
8994 elfcore_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
8995 {
8996 size_t size;
8997 int offset;
8998
8999 if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus_t))
9000 {
9001 prstatus_t prstat;
9002
9003 size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
9004 offset = offsetof (prstatus_t, pr_reg);
9005 memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
9006
9007 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
9008 has already been set by another thread. */
9009 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9010 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
9011 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
9012 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
9013
9014 /* pr_who exists on:
9015 solaris 2.5+
9016 unixware 4.2
9017 pr_who doesn't exist on:
9018 linux 2.[01]
9019 */
9020 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T_PR_WHO)
9021 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
9022 #else
9023 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
9024 #endif
9025 }
9026 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
9027 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus32_t))
9028 {
9029 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9030 prstatus32_t prstat;
9031
9032 size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
9033 offset = offsetof (prstatus32_t, pr_reg);
9034 memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
9035
9036 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
9037 has already been set by another thread. */
9038 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9039 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
9040 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
9041 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
9042
9043 /* pr_who exists on:
9044 solaris 2.5+
9045 unixware 4.2
9046 pr_who doesn't exist on:
9047 linux 2.[01]
9048 */
9049 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T_PR_WHO)
9050 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
9051 #else
9052 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
9053 #endif
9054 }
9055 #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T */
9056 else
9057 {
9058 /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
9059 note size (ie. data object type). */
9060 return TRUE;
9061 }
9062
9063 /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section. */
9064 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
9065 size, note->descpos + offset);
9066 }
9067 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T) */
9068
9069 /* Create a pseudosection containing the exact contents of NOTE. */
9070 static bfd_boolean
9071 elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
9072 char *name,
9073 Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9074 {
9075 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, name,
9076 note->descsz, note->descpos);
9077 }
9078
9079 /* There isn't a consistent prfpregset_t across platforms,
9080 but it doesn't matter, because we don't have to pick this
9081 data structure apart. */
9082
9083 static bfd_boolean
9084 elfcore_grok_prfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9085 {
9086 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
9087 }
9088
9089 /* Linux dumps the Intel SSE regs in a note named "LINUX" with a note
9090 type of NT_PRXFPREG. Just include the whole note's contents
9091 literally. */
9092
9093 static bfd_boolean
9094 elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9095 {
9096 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
9097 }
9098
9099 /* Linux dumps the Intel XSAVE extended state in a note named "LINUX"
9100 with a note type of NT_X86_XSTATE. Just include the whole note's
9101 contents literally. */
9102
9103 static bfd_boolean
9104 elfcore_grok_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9105 {
9106 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xstate", note);
9107 }
9108
9109 static bfd_boolean
9110 elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9111 {
9112 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vmx", note);
9113 }
9114
9115 static bfd_boolean
9116 elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9117 {
9118 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vsx", note);
9119 }
9120
9121 static bfd_boolean
9122 elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9123 {
9124 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-high-gprs", note);
9125 }
9126
9127 static bfd_boolean
9128 elfcore_grok_s390_timer (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9129 {
9130 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-timer", note);
9131 }
9132
9133 static bfd_boolean
9134 elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9135 {
9136 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todcmp", note);
9137 }
9138
9139 static bfd_boolean
9140 elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9141 {
9142 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todpreg", note);
9143 }
9144
9145 static bfd_boolean
9146 elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9147 {
9148 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-ctrs", note);
9149 }
9150
9151 static bfd_boolean
9152 elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9153 {
9154 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-prefix", note);
9155 }
9156
9157 static bfd_boolean
9158 elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9159 {
9160 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-last-break", note);
9161 }
9162
9163 static bfd_boolean
9164 elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9165 {
9166 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-system-call", note);
9167 }
9168
9169 static bfd_boolean
9170 elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9171 {
9172 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-tdb", note);
9173 }
9174
9175 static bfd_boolean
9176 elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9177 {
9178 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low", note);
9179 }
9180
9181 static bfd_boolean
9182 elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9183 {
9184 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high", note);
9185 }
9186
9187 static bfd_boolean
9188 elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9189 {
9190 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-arm-vfp", note);
9191 }
9192
9193 static bfd_boolean
9194 elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9195 {
9196 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-tls", note);
9197 }
9198
9199 static bfd_boolean
9200 elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9201 {
9202 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-break", note);
9203 }
9204
9205 static bfd_boolean
9206 elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9207 {
9208 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch", note);
9209 }
9210
9211 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T)
9212 typedef prpsinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
9213 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
9214 typedef prpsinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
9215 #endif
9216 #endif
9217
9218 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9219 typedef psinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
9220 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
9221 typedef psinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
9222 #endif
9223 #endif
9224
9225 /* return a malloc'ed copy of a string at START which is at
9226 most MAX bytes long, possibly without a terminating '\0'.
9227 the copy will always have a terminating '\0'. */
9228
9229 char *
9230 _bfd_elfcore_strndup (bfd *abfd, char *start, size_t max)
9231 {
9232 char *dups;
9233 char *end = (char *) memchr (start, '\0', max);
9234 size_t len;
9235
9236 if (end == NULL)
9237 len = max;
9238 else
9239 len = end - start;
9240
9241 dups = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 1);
9242 if (dups == NULL)
9243 return NULL;
9244
9245 memcpy (dups, start, len);
9246 dups[len] = '\0';
9247
9248 return dups;
9249 }
9250
9251 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9252 static bfd_boolean
9253 elfcore_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9254 {
9255 if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo_t))
9256 {
9257 elfcore_psinfo_t psinfo;
9258
9259 memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
9260
9261 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T_PR_PID)
9262 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
9263 #endif
9264 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
9265 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
9266 sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
9267
9268 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
9269 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
9270 sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
9271 }
9272 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
9273 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo32_t))
9274 {
9275 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9276 elfcore_psinfo32_t psinfo;
9277
9278 memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
9279
9280 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T_PR_PID)
9281 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
9282 #endif
9283 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
9284 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
9285 sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
9286
9287 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
9288 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
9289 sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
9290 }
9291 #endif
9292
9293 else
9294 {
9295 /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
9296 note size (ie. data object type). */
9297 return TRUE;
9298 }
9299
9300 /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
9301 onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
9302 implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
9303
9304 {
9305 char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
9306 int n = strlen (command);
9307
9308 if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
9309 command[n - 1] = '\0';
9310 }
9311
9312 return TRUE;
9313 }
9314 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T) */
9315
9316 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
9317 static bfd_boolean
9318 elfcore_grok_pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9319 {
9320 if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus_t)
9321 #if defined (HAVE_PXSTATUS_T)
9322 || note->descsz == sizeof (pxstatus_t)
9323 #endif
9324 )
9325 {
9326 pstatus_t pstat;
9327
9328 memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
9329
9330 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
9331 }
9332 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
9333 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus32_t))
9334 {
9335 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9336 pstatus32_t pstat;
9337
9338 memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
9339
9340 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
9341 }
9342 #endif
9343 /* Could grab some more details from the "representative"
9344 lwpstatus_t in pstat.pr_lwp, but we'll catch it all in an
9345 NT_LWPSTATUS note, presumably. */
9346
9347 return TRUE;
9348 }
9349 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T) */
9350
9351 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
9352 static bfd_boolean
9353 elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9354 {
9355 lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
9356 char buf[100];
9357 char *name;
9358 size_t len;
9359 asection *sect;
9360
9361 if (note->descsz != sizeof (lwpstat)
9362 #if defined (HAVE_LWPXSTATUS_T)
9363 && note->descsz != sizeof (lwpxstatus_t)
9364 #endif
9365 )
9366 return TRUE;
9367
9368 memcpy (&lwpstat, note->descdata, sizeof (lwpstat));
9369
9370 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwpstat.pr_lwpid;
9371 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it has already been set by
9372 another thread. */
9373 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9374 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = lwpstat.pr_cursig;
9375
9376 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
9377
9378 sprintf (buf, ".reg/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
9379 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9380 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9381 if (name == NULL)
9382 return FALSE;
9383 memcpy (name, buf, len);
9384
9385 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9386 if (sect == NULL)
9387 return FALSE;
9388
9389 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
9390 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
9391 sect->filepos = note->descpos
9392 + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
9393 #endif
9394
9395 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
9396 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg);
9397 sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_reg);
9398 #endif
9399
9400 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9401
9402 if (!elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
9403 return FALSE;
9404
9405 /* Make a ".reg2/999" section */
9406
9407 sprintf (buf, ".reg2/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
9408 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9409 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9410 if (name == NULL)
9411 return FALSE;
9412 memcpy (name, buf, len);
9413
9414 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9415 if (sect == NULL)
9416 return FALSE;
9417
9418 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
9419 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
9420 sect->filepos = note->descpos
9421 + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
9422 #endif
9423
9424 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_FPREG)
9425 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_fpreg);
9426 sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_fpreg);
9427 #endif
9428
9429 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9430
9431 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg2", sect);
9432 }
9433 #endif /* defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T) */
9434
9435 static bfd_boolean
9436 elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9437 {
9438 char buf[30];
9439 char *name;
9440 size_t len;
9441 asection *sect;
9442 int type;
9443 int is_active_thread;
9444 bfd_vma base_addr;
9445
9446 if (note->descsz < 728)
9447 return TRUE;
9448
9449 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (note->namedata, "win32"))
9450 return TRUE;
9451
9452 type = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata);
9453
9454 switch (type)
9455 {
9456 case 1 /* NOTE_INFO_PROCESS */:
9457 /* FIXME: need to add ->core->command. */
9458 /* process_info.pid */
9459 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
9460 /* process_info.signal */
9461 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
9462 break;
9463
9464 case 2 /* NOTE_INFO_THREAD */:
9465 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
9466 /* thread_info.tid */
9467 sprintf (buf, ".reg/%ld", (long) bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8));
9468
9469 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9470 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9471 if (name == NULL)
9472 return FALSE;
9473
9474 memcpy (name, buf, len);
9475
9476 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9477 if (sect == NULL)
9478 return FALSE;
9479
9480 /* sizeof (thread_info.thread_context) */
9481 sect->size = 716;
9482 /* offsetof (thread_info.thread_context) */
9483 sect->filepos = note->descpos + 12;
9484 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9485
9486 /* thread_info.is_active_thread */
9487 is_active_thread = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
9488
9489 if (is_active_thread)
9490 if (! elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
9491 return FALSE;
9492 break;
9493
9494 case 3 /* NOTE_INFO_MODULE */:
9495 /* Make a ".module/xxxxxxxx" section. */
9496 /* module_info.base_address */
9497 base_addr = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 4);
9498 sprintf (buf, ".module/%08lx", (unsigned long) base_addr);
9499
9500 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9501 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9502 if (name == NULL)
9503 return FALSE;
9504
9505 memcpy (name, buf, len);
9506
9507 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9508
9509 if (sect == NULL)
9510 return FALSE;
9511
9512 sect->size = note->descsz;
9513 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
9514 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9515 break;
9516
9517 default:
9518 return TRUE;
9519 }
9520
9521 return TRUE;
9522 }
9523
9524 static bfd_boolean
9525 elfcore_grok_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9526 {
9527 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
9528
9529 switch (note->type)
9530 {
9531 default:
9532 return TRUE;
9533
9534 case NT_PRSTATUS:
9535 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus)
9536 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus) (abfd, note))
9537 return TRUE;
9538 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
9539 return elfcore_grok_prstatus (abfd, note);
9540 #else
9541 return TRUE;
9542 #endif
9543
9544 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
9545 case NT_PSTATUS:
9546 return elfcore_grok_pstatus (abfd, note);
9547 #endif
9548
9549 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
9550 case NT_LWPSTATUS:
9551 return elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (abfd, note);
9552 #endif
9553
9554 case NT_FPREGSET: /* FIXME: rename to NT_PRFPREG */
9555 return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
9556
9557 case NT_WIN32PSTATUS:
9558 return elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (abfd, note);
9559
9560 case NT_PRXFPREG: /* Linux SSE extension */
9561 if (note->namesz == 6
9562 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9563 return elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (abfd, note);
9564 else
9565 return TRUE;
9566
9567 case NT_X86_XSTATE: /* Linux XSAVE extension */
9568 if (note->namesz == 6
9569 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9570 return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
9571 else
9572 return TRUE;
9573
9574 case NT_PPC_VMX:
9575 if (note->namesz == 6
9576 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9577 return elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (abfd, note);
9578 else
9579 return TRUE;
9580
9581 case NT_PPC_VSX:
9582 if (note->namesz == 6
9583 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9584 return elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (abfd, note);
9585 else
9586 return TRUE;
9587
9588 case NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS:
9589 if (note->namesz == 6
9590 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9591 return elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (abfd, note);
9592 else
9593 return TRUE;
9594
9595 case NT_S390_TIMER:
9596 if (note->namesz == 6
9597 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9598 return elfcore_grok_s390_timer (abfd, note);
9599 else
9600 return TRUE;
9601
9602 case NT_S390_TODCMP:
9603 if (note->namesz == 6
9604 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9605 return elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (abfd, note);
9606 else
9607 return TRUE;
9608
9609 case NT_S390_TODPREG:
9610 if (note->namesz == 6
9611 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9612 return elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (abfd, note);
9613 else
9614 return TRUE;
9615
9616 case NT_S390_CTRS:
9617 if (note->namesz == 6
9618 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9619 return elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (abfd, note);
9620 else
9621 return TRUE;
9622
9623 case NT_S390_PREFIX:
9624 if (note->namesz == 6
9625 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9626 return elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (abfd, note);
9627 else
9628 return TRUE;
9629
9630 case NT_S390_LAST_BREAK:
9631 if (note->namesz == 6
9632 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9633 return elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (abfd, note);
9634 else
9635 return TRUE;
9636
9637 case NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL:
9638 if (note->namesz == 6
9639 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9640 return elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (abfd, note);
9641 else
9642 return TRUE;
9643
9644 case NT_S390_TDB:
9645 if (note->namesz == 6
9646 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9647 return elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (abfd, note);
9648 else
9649 return TRUE;
9650
9651 case NT_S390_VXRS_LOW:
9652 if (note->namesz == 6
9653 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9654 return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (abfd, note);
9655 else
9656 return TRUE;
9657
9658 case NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH:
9659 if (note->namesz == 6
9660 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9661 return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (abfd, note);
9662 else
9663 return TRUE;
9664
9665 case NT_ARM_VFP:
9666 if (note->namesz == 6
9667 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9668 return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd, note);
9669 else
9670 return TRUE;
9671
9672 case NT_ARM_TLS:
9673 if (note->namesz == 6
9674 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9675 return elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (abfd, note);
9676 else
9677 return TRUE;
9678
9679 case NT_ARM_HW_BREAK:
9680 if (note->namesz == 6
9681 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9682 return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (abfd, note);
9683 else
9684 return TRUE;
9685
9686 case NT_ARM_HW_WATCH:
9687 if (note->namesz == 6
9688 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
9689 return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, note);
9690 else
9691 return TRUE;
9692
9693 case NT_PRPSINFO:
9694 case NT_PSINFO:
9695 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo)
9696 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo) (abfd, note))
9697 return TRUE;
9698 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9699 return elfcore_grok_psinfo (abfd, note);
9700 #else
9701 return TRUE;
9702 #endif
9703
9704 case NT_AUXV:
9705 {
9706 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
9707 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9708
9709 if (sect == NULL)
9710 return FALSE;
9711 sect->size = note->descsz;
9712 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
9713 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
9714
9715 return TRUE;
9716 }
9717
9718 case NT_FILE:
9719 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.file",
9720 note);
9721
9722 case NT_SIGINFO:
9723 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.siginfo",
9724 note);
9725
9726 }
9727 }
9728
9729 static bfd_boolean
9730 elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9731 {
9732 struct bfd_build_id* build_id;
9733
9734 if (note->descsz == 0)
9735 return FALSE;
9736
9737 build_id = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct bfd_build_id) - 1 + note->descsz);
9738 if (build_id == NULL)
9739 return FALSE;
9740
9741 build_id->size = note->descsz;
9742 memcpy (build_id->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
9743 abfd->build_id = build_id;
9744
9745 return TRUE;
9746 }
9747
9748 static bfd_boolean
9749 elfobj_grok_gnu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9750 {
9751 switch (note->type)
9752 {
9753 default:
9754 return TRUE;
9755
9756 case NT_GNU_PROPERTY_TYPE_0:
9757 return _bfd_elf_parse_gnu_properties (abfd, note);
9758
9759 case NT_GNU_BUILD_ID:
9760 return elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (abfd, note);
9761 }
9762 }
9763
9764 static bfd_boolean
9765 elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9766 {
9767 struct sdt_note *cur =
9768 (struct sdt_note *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct sdt_note)
9769 + note->descsz);
9770
9771 cur->next = (struct sdt_note *) (elf_tdata (abfd))->sdt_note_head;
9772 cur->size = (bfd_size_type) note->descsz;
9773 memcpy (cur->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
9774
9775 elf_tdata (abfd)->sdt_note_head = cur;
9776
9777 return TRUE;
9778 }
9779
9780 static bfd_boolean
9781 elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9782 {
9783 switch (note->type)
9784 {
9785 case NT_STAPSDT:
9786 return elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (abfd, note);
9787
9788 default:
9789 return TRUE;
9790 }
9791 }
9792
9793 static bfd_boolean
9794 elfcore_grok_freebsd_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9795 {
9796 size_t offset;
9797
9798 switch (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word)
9799 {
9800 case 32:
9801 if (note->descsz < 108)
9802 return FALSE;
9803 break;
9804
9805 case 64:
9806 if (note->descsz < 120)
9807 return FALSE;
9808 break;
9809
9810 default:
9811 return FALSE;
9812 }
9813
9814 /* Check for version 1 in pr_version. */
9815 if (bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata) != 1)
9816 return FALSE;
9817 offset = 4;
9818
9819 /* Skip over pr_psinfosz. */
9820 if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32)
9821 offset += 4;
9822 else
9823 {
9824 offset += 4; /* Padding before pr_psinfosz. */
9825 offset += 8;
9826 }
9827
9828 /* pr_fname is PRFNAMESZ (16) + 1 bytes in size. */
9829 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
9830 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + offset, 17);
9831 offset += 17;
9832
9833 /* pr_psargs is PRARGSZ (80) + 1 bytes in size. */
9834 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
9835 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + offset, 81);
9836 offset += 81;
9837
9838 /* Padding before pr_pid. */
9839 offset += 2;
9840
9841 /* The pr_pid field was added in version "1a". */
9842 if (note->descsz < offset + 4)
9843 return TRUE;
9844
9845 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
9846 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
9847
9848 return TRUE;
9849 }
9850
9851 static bfd_boolean
9852 elfcore_grok_freebsd_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9853 {
9854 size_t offset;
9855 size_t size;
9856
9857 /* Check for version 1 in pr_version. */
9858 if (bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata) != 1)
9859 return FALSE;
9860 offset = 4;
9861
9862 /* Skip over pr_statussz. */
9863 switch (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word)
9864 {
9865 case 32:
9866 offset += 4;
9867 break;
9868
9869 case 64:
9870 offset += 4; /* Padding before pr_statussz. */
9871 offset += 8;
9872 break;
9873
9874 default:
9875 return FALSE;
9876 }
9877
9878 /* Extract size of pr_reg from pr_gregsetsz. */
9879 if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32)
9880 size = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
9881 else
9882 size = bfd_h_get_64 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
9883
9884 /* Skip over pr_gregsetsz and pr_fpregsetsz. */
9885 offset += (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word / 8) * 2;
9886
9887 /* Skip over pr_osreldate. */
9888 offset += 4;
9889
9890 /* Read signal from pr_cursig. */
9891 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9892 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
9893 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
9894 offset += 4;
9895
9896 /* Read TID from pr_pid. */
9897 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid
9898 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
9899 offset += 4;
9900
9901 /* Padding before pr_reg. */
9902 if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 64)
9903 offset += 4;
9904
9905 /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section. */
9906 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
9907 size, note->descpos + offset);
9908 }
9909
9910 static bfd_boolean
9911 elfcore_grok_freebsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9912 {
9913 switch (note->type)
9914 {
9915 case NT_PRSTATUS:
9916 return elfcore_grok_freebsd_prstatus (abfd, note);
9917
9918 case NT_FPREGSET:
9919 return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
9920
9921 case NT_PRPSINFO:
9922 return elfcore_grok_freebsd_psinfo (abfd, note);
9923
9924 case NT_FREEBSD_THRMISC:
9925 if (note->namesz == 8)
9926 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".thrmisc", note);
9927 else
9928 return TRUE;
9929
9930 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_AUXV:
9931 {
9932 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
9933 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9934
9935 if (sect == NULL)
9936 return FALSE;
9937 sect->size = note->descsz - 4;
9938 sect->filepos = note->descpos + 4;
9939 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
9940
9941 return TRUE;
9942 }
9943
9944 case NT_X86_XSTATE:
9945 if (note->namesz == 8)
9946 return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
9947 else
9948 return TRUE;
9949
9950 default:
9951 return TRUE;
9952 }
9953 }
9954
9955 static bfd_boolean
9956 elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (Elf_Internal_Note *note, int *lwpidp)
9957 {
9958 char *cp;
9959
9960 cp = strchr (note->namedata, '@');
9961 if (cp != NULL)
9962 {
9963 *lwpidp = atoi(cp + 1);
9964 return TRUE;
9965 }
9966 return FALSE;
9967 }
9968
9969 static bfd_boolean
9970 elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9971 {
9972 /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
9973 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
9974 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
9975
9976 /* Process ID at offset 0x50. */
9977 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
9978 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x50);
9979
9980 /* Command name at 0x7c (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
9981 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
9982 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x7c, 31);
9983
9984 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.netbsdcore.procinfo",
9985 note);
9986 }
9987
9988 static bfd_boolean
9989 elfcore_grok_netbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9990 {
9991 int lwp;
9992
9993 if (elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (note, &lwp))
9994 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwp;
9995
9996 if (note->type == NT_NETBSDCORE_PROCINFO)
9997 {
9998 /* NetBSD-specific core "procinfo". Note that we expect to
9999 find this note before any of the others, which is fine,
10000 since the kernel writes this note out first when it
10001 creates a core file. */
10002
10003 return elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
10004 }
10005
10006 /* As of Jan 2002 there are no other machine-independent notes
10007 defined for NetBSD core files. If the note type is less
10008 than the start of the machine-dependent note types, we don't
10009 understand it. */
10010
10011 if (note->type < NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH)
10012 return TRUE;
10013
10014
10015 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
10016 {
10017 /* On the Alpha, SPARC (32-bit and 64-bit), PT_GETREGS == mach+0 and
10018 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+2. */
10019
10020 case bfd_arch_alpha:
10021 case bfd_arch_sparc:
10022 switch (note->type)
10023 {
10024 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+0:
10025 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10026
10027 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+2:
10028 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10029
10030 default:
10031 return TRUE;
10032 }
10033
10034 /* On all other arch's, PT_GETREGS == mach+1 and
10035 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+3. */
10036
10037 default:
10038 switch (note->type)
10039 {
10040 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+1:
10041 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10042
10043 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+3:
10044 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10045
10046 default:
10047 return TRUE;
10048 }
10049 }
10050 /* NOTREACHED */
10051 }
10052
10053 static bfd_boolean
10054 elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10055 {
10056 /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
10057 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
10058 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
10059
10060 /* Process ID at offset 0x20. */
10061 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
10062 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x20);
10063
10064 /* Command name at 0x48 (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
10065 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
10066 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x48, 31);
10067
10068 return TRUE;
10069 }
10070
10071 static bfd_boolean
10072 elfcore_grok_openbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10073 {
10074 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_PROCINFO)
10075 return elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
10076
10077 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_REGS)
10078 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10079
10080 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_FPREGS)
10081 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10082
10083 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_XFPREGS)
10084 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
10085
10086 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_AUXV)
10087 {
10088 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
10089 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10090
10091 if (sect == NULL)
10092 return FALSE;
10093 sect->size = note->descsz;
10094 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10095 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
10096
10097 return TRUE;
10098 }
10099
10100 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_WCOOKIE)
10101 {
10102 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".wcookie",
10103 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10104
10105 if (sect == NULL)
10106 return FALSE;
10107 sect->size = note->descsz;
10108 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10109 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
10110
10111 return TRUE;
10112 }
10113
10114 return TRUE;
10115 }
10116
10117 static bfd_boolean
10118 elfcore_grok_nto_status (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note, long *tid)
10119 {
10120 void *ddata = note->descdata;
10121 char buf[100];
10122 char *name;
10123 asection *sect;
10124 short sig;
10125 unsigned flags;
10126
10127 /* nto_procfs_status 'pid' field is at offset 0. */
10128 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata);
10129
10130 /* nto_procfs_status 'tid' field is at offset 4. Pass it back. */
10131 *tid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 4);
10132
10133 /* nto_procfs_status 'flags' field is at offset 8. */
10134 flags = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 8);
10135
10136 /* nto_procfs_status 'what' field is at offset 14. */
10137 if ((sig = bfd_get_16 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 14)) > 0)
10138 {
10139 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = sig;
10140 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
10141 }
10142
10143 /* _DEBUG_FLAG_CURTID (current thread) is 0x80. Some cores
10144 do not come from signals so we make sure we set the current
10145 thread just in case. */
10146 if (flags & 0x00000080)
10147 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
10148
10149 /* Make a ".qnx_core_status/%d" section. */
10150 sprintf (buf, ".qnx_core_status/%ld", *tid);
10151
10152 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
10153 if (name == NULL)
10154 return FALSE;
10155 strcpy (name, buf);
10156
10157 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10158 if (sect == NULL)
10159 return FALSE;
10160
10161 sect->size = note->descsz;
10162 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10163 sect->alignment_power = 2;
10164
10165 return (elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".qnx_core_status", sect));
10166 }
10167
10168 static bfd_boolean
10169 elfcore_grok_nto_regs (bfd *abfd,
10170 Elf_Internal_Note *note,
10171 long tid,
10172 char *base)
10173 {
10174 char buf[100];
10175 char *name;
10176 asection *sect;
10177
10178 /* Make a "(base)/%d" section. */
10179 sprintf (buf, "%s/%ld", base, tid);
10180
10181 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
10182 if (name == NULL)
10183 return FALSE;
10184 strcpy (name, buf);
10185
10186 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10187 if (sect == NULL)
10188 return FALSE;
10189
10190 sect->size = note->descsz;
10191 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10192 sect->alignment_power = 2;
10193
10194 /* This is the current thread. */
10195 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid == tid)
10196 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, base, sect);
10197
10198 return TRUE;
10199 }
10200
10201 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO 7
10202 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS 8
10203 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG 9
10204 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG 10
10205
10206 static bfd_boolean
10207 elfcore_grok_nto_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10208 {
10209 /* Every GREG section has a STATUS section before it. Store the
10210 tid from the previous call to pass down to the next gregs
10211 function. */
10212 static long tid = 1;
10213
10214 switch (note->type)
10215 {
10216 case BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO:
10217 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".qnx_core_info", note);
10218 case BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS:
10219 return elfcore_grok_nto_status (abfd, note, &tid);
10220 case BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG:
10221 return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg");
10222 case BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG:
10223 return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg2");
10224 default:
10225 return TRUE;
10226 }
10227 }
10228
10229 static bfd_boolean
10230 elfcore_grok_spu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10231 {
10232 char *name;
10233 asection *sect;
10234 size_t len;
10235
10236 /* Use note name as section name. */
10237 len = note->namesz;
10238 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
10239 if (name == NULL)
10240 return FALSE;
10241 memcpy (name, note->namedata, len);
10242 name[len - 1] = '\0';
10243
10244 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10245 if (sect == NULL)
10246 return FALSE;
10247
10248 sect->size = note->descsz;
10249 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10250 sect->alignment_power = 1;
10251
10252 return TRUE;
10253 }
10254
10255 /* Function: elfcore_write_note
10256
10257 Inputs:
10258 buffer to hold note, and current size of buffer
10259 name of note
10260 type of note
10261 data for note
10262 size of data for note
10263
10264 Writes note to end of buffer. ELF64 notes are written exactly as
10265 for ELF32, despite the current (as of 2006) ELF gabi specifying
10266 that they ought to have 8-byte namesz and descsz field, and have
10267 8-byte alignment. Other writers, eg. Linux kernel, do the same.
10268
10269 Return:
10270 Pointer to realloc'd buffer, *BUFSIZ updated. */
10271
10272 char *
10273 elfcore_write_note (bfd *abfd,
10274 char *buf,
10275 int *bufsiz,
10276 const char *name,
10277 int type,
10278 const void *input,
10279 int size)
10280 {
10281 Elf_External_Note *xnp;
10282 size_t namesz;
10283 size_t newspace;
10284 char *dest;
10285
10286 namesz = 0;
10287 if (name != NULL)
10288 namesz = strlen (name) + 1;
10289
10290 newspace = 12 + ((namesz + 3) & -4) + ((size + 3) & -4);
10291
10292 buf = (char *) realloc (buf, *bufsiz + newspace);
10293 if (buf == NULL)
10294 return buf;
10295 dest = buf + *bufsiz;
10296 *bufsiz += newspace;
10297 xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) dest;
10298 H_PUT_32 (abfd, namesz, xnp->namesz);
10299 H_PUT_32 (abfd, size, xnp->descsz);
10300 H_PUT_32 (abfd, type, xnp->type);
10301 dest = xnp->name;
10302 if (name != NULL)
10303 {
10304 memcpy (dest, name, namesz);
10305 dest += namesz;
10306 while (namesz & 3)
10307 {
10308 *dest++ = '\0';
10309 ++namesz;
10310 }
10311 }
10312 memcpy (dest, input, size);
10313 dest += size;
10314 while (size & 3)
10315 {
10316 *dest++ = '\0';
10317 ++size;
10318 }
10319 return buf;
10320 }
10321
10322 char *
10323 elfcore_write_prpsinfo (bfd *abfd,
10324 char *buf,
10325 int *bufsiz,
10326 const char *fname,
10327 const char *psargs)
10328 {
10329 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10330
10331 if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
10332 {
10333 char *ret;
10334 ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10335 NT_PRPSINFO, fname, psargs);
10336 if (ret != NULL)
10337 return ret;
10338 }
10339
10340 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
10341 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
10342 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
10343 {
10344 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
10345 psinfo32_t data;
10346 int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
10347 #else
10348 prpsinfo32_t data;
10349 int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
10350 #endif
10351
10352 memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
10353 strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
10354 strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
10355 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10356 "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
10357 }
10358 else
10359 #endif
10360 {
10361 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
10362 psinfo_t data;
10363 int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
10364 #else
10365 prpsinfo_t data;
10366 int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
10367 #endif
10368
10369 memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
10370 strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
10371 strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
10372 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10373 "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
10374 }
10375 #endif /* PSINFO_T or PRPSINFO_T */
10376
10377 free (buf);
10378 return NULL;
10379 }
10380
10381 char *
10382 elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo32
10383 (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
10384 const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
10385 {
10386 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo32 data;
10387
10388 swap_linux_prpsinfo32_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
10389 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO,
10390 &data, sizeof (data));
10391 }
10392
10393 char *
10394 elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo64
10395 (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
10396 const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
10397 {
10398 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo64 data;
10399
10400 swap_linux_prpsinfo64_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
10401 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10402 "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO, &data, sizeof (data));
10403 }
10404
10405 char *
10406 elfcore_write_prstatus (bfd *abfd,
10407 char *buf,
10408 int *bufsiz,
10409 long pid,
10410 int cursig,
10411 const void *gregs)
10412 {
10413 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10414
10415 if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
10416 {
10417 char *ret;
10418 ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10419 NT_PRSTATUS,
10420 pid, cursig, gregs);
10421 if (ret != NULL)
10422 return ret;
10423 }
10424
10425 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
10426 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
10427 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
10428 {
10429 prstatus32_t prstat;
10430
10431 memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
10432 prstat.pr_pid = pid;
10433 prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
10434 memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
10435 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
10436 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
10437 }
10438 else
10439 #endif
10440 {
10441 prstatus_t prstat;
10442
10443 memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
10444 prstat.pr_pid = pid;
10445 prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
10446 memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
10447 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
10448 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
10449 }
10450 #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS_T */
10451
10452 free (buf);
10453 return NULL;
10454 }
10455
10456 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
10457 char *
10458 elfcore_write_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd,
10459 char *buf,
10460 int *bufsiz,
10461 long pid,
10462 int cursig,
10463 const void *gregs)
10464 {
10465 lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
10466 const char *note_name = "CORE";
10467
10468 memset (&lwpstat, 0, sizeof (lwpstat));
10469 lwpstat.pr_lwpid = pid >> 16;
10470 lwpstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
10471 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
10472 memcpy (&lwpstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg));
10473 #elif defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
10474 #if !defined(gregs)
10475 memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs,
10476 gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs));
10477 #else
10478 memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs,
10479 gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs));
10480 #endif
10481 #endif
10482 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
10483 NT_LWPSTATUS, &lwpstat, sizeof (lwpstat));
10484 }
10485 #endif /* HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T */
10486
10487 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
10488 char *
10489 elfcore_write_pstatus (bfd *abfd,
10490 char *buf,
10491 int *bufsiz,
10492 long pid,
10493 int cursig ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
10494 const void *gregs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
10495 {
10496 const char *note_name = "CORE";
10497 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
10498 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10499
10500 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
10501 {
10502 pstatus32_t pstat;
10503
10504 memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
10505 pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
10506 buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
10507 NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
10508 return buf;
10509 }
10510 else
10511 #endif
10512 {
10513 pstatus_t pstat;
10514
10515 memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
10516 pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
10517 buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
10518 NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
10519 return buf;
10520 }
10521 }
10522 #endif /* HAVE_PSTATUS_T */
10523
10524 char *
10525 elfcore_write_prfpreg (bfd *abfd,
10526 char *buf,
10527 int *bufsiz,
10528 const void *fpregs,
10529 int size)
10530 {
10531 const char *note_name = "CORE";
10532 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10533 note_name, NT_FPREGSET, fpregs, size);
10534 }
10535
10536 char *
10537 elfcore_write_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd,
10538 char *buf,
10539 int *bufsiz,
10540 const void *xfpregs,
10541 int size)
10542 {
10543 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10544 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10545 note_name, NT_PRXFPREG, xfpregs, size);
10546 }
10547
10548 char *
10549 elfcore_write_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
10550 const void *xfpregs, int size)
10551 {
10552 char *note_name;
10553 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi == ELFOSABI_FREEBSD)
10554 note_name = "FreeBSD";
10555 else
10556 note_name = "LINUX";
10557 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10558 note_name, NT_X86_XSTATE, xfpregs, size);
10559 }
10560
10561 char *
10562 elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd,
10563 char *buf,
10564 int *bufsiz,
10565 const void *ppc_vmx,
10566 int size)
10567 {
10568 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10569 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10570 note_name, NT_PPC_VMX, ppc_vmx, size);
10571 }
10572
10573 char *
10574 elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd,
10575 char *buf,
10576 int *bufsiz,
10577 const void *ppc_vsx,
10578 int size)
10579 {
10580 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10581 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10582 note_name, NT_PPC_VSX, ppc_vsx, size);
10583 }
10584
10585 static char *
10586 elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd,
10587 char *buf,
10588 int *bufsiz,
10589 const void *s390_high_gprs,
10590 int size)
10591 {
10592 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10593 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10594 note_name, NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS,
10595 s390_high_gprs, size);
10596 }
10597
10598 char *
10599 elfcore_write_s390_timer (bfd *abfd,
10600 char *buf,
10601 int *bufsiz,
10602 const void *s390_timer,
10603 int size)
10604 {
10605 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10606 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10607 note_name, NT_S390_TIMER, s390_timer, size);
10608 }
10609
10610 char *
10611 elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd,
10612 char *buf,
10613 int *bufsiz,
10614 const void *s390_todcmp,
10615 int size)
10616 {
10617 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10618 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10619 note_name, NT_S390_TODCMP, s390_todcmp, size);
10620 }
10621
10622 char *
10623 elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd,
10624 char *buf,
10625 int *bufsiz,
10626 const void *s390_todpreg,
10627 int size)
10628 {
10629 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10630 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10631 note_name, NT_S390_TODPREG, s390_todpreg, size);
10632 }
10633
10634 char *
10635 elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd,
10636 char *buf,
10637 int *bufsiz,
10638 const void *s390_ctrs,
10639 int size)
10640 {
10641 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10642 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10643 note_name, NT_S390_CTRS, s390_ctrs, size);
10644 }
10645
10646 char *
10647 elfcore_write_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd,
10648 char *buf,
10649 int *bufsiz,
10650 const void *s390_prefix,
10651 int size)
10652 {
10653 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10654 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10655 note_name, NT_S390_PREFIX, s390_prefix, size);
10656 }
10657
10658 char *
10659 elfcore_write_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd,
10660 char *buf,
10661 int *bufsiz,
10662 const void *s390_last_break,
10663 int size)
10664 {
10665 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10666 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10667 note_name, NT_S390_LAST_BREAK,
10668 s390_last_break, size);
10669 }
10670
10671 char *
10672 elfcore_write_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd,
10673 char *buf,
10674 int *bufsiz,
10675 const void *s390_system_call,
10676 int size)
10677 {
10678 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10679 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10680 note_name, NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL,
10681 s390_system_call, size);
10682 }
10683
10684 char *
10685 elfcore_write_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd,
10686 char *buf,
10687 int *bufsiz,
10688 const void *s390_tdb,
10689 int size)
10690 {
10691 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10692 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10693 note_name, NT_S390_TDB, s390_tdb, size);
10694 }
10695
10696 char *
10697 elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (bfd *abfd,
10698 char *buf,
10699 int *bufsiz,
10700 const void *s390_vxrs_low,
10701 int size)
10702 {
10703 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10704 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10705 note_name, NT_S390_VXRS_LOW, s390_vxrs_low, size);
10706 }
10707
10708 char *
10709 elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (bfd *abfd,
10710 char *buf,
10711 int *bufsiz,
10712 const void *s390_vxrs_high,
10713 int size)
10714 {
10715 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10716 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10717 note_name, NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH,
10718 s390_vxrs_high, size);
10719 }
10720
10721 char *
10722 elfcore_write_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd,
10723 char *buf,
10724 int *bufsiz,
10725 const void *arm_vfp,
10726 int size)
10727 {
10728 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10729 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10730 note_name, NT_ARM_VFP, arm_vfp, size);
10731 }
10732
10733 char *
10734 elfcore_write_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd,
10735 char *buf,
10736 int *bufsiz,
10737 const void *aarch_tls,
10738 int size)
10739 {
10740 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10741 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10742 note_name, NT_ARM_TLS, aarch_tls, size);
10743 }
10744
10745 char *
10746 elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd,
10747 char *buf,
10748 int *bufsiz,
10749 const void *aarch_hw_break,
10750 int size)
10751 {
10752 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10753 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10754 note_name, NT_ARM_HW_BREAK, aarch_hw_break, size);
10755 }
10756
10757 char *
10758 elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd,
10759 char *buf,
10760 int *bufsiz,
10761 const void *aarch_hw_watch,
10762 int size)
10763 {
10764 char *note_name = "LINUX";
10765 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
10766 note_name, NT_ARM_HW_WATCH, aarch_hw_watch, size);
10767 }
10768
10769 char *
10770 elfcore_write_register_note (bfd *abfd,
10771 char *buf,
10772 int *bufsiz,
10773 const char *section,
10774 const void *data,
10775 int size)
10776 {
10777 if (strcmp (section, ".reg2") == 0)
10778 return elfcore_write_prfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10779 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xfp") == 0)
10780 return elfcore_write_prxfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10781 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xstate") == 0)
10782 return elfcore_write_xstatereg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10783 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vmx") == 0)
10784 return elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10785 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vsx") == 0)
10786 return elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10787 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-high-gprs") == 0)
10788 return elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10789 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-timer") == 0)
10790 return elfcore_write_s390_timer (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10791 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todcmp") == 0)
10792 return elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10793 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todpreg") == 0)
10794 return elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10795 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-ctrs") == 0)
10796 return elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10797 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-prefix") == 0)
10798 return elfcore_write_s390_prefix (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10799 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-last-break") == 0)
10800 return elfcore_write_s390_last_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10801 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-system-call") == 0)
10802 return elfcore_write_s390_system_call (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10803 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-tdb") == 0)
10804 return elfcore_write_s390_tdb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10805 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low") == 0)
10806 return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10807 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high") == 0)
10808 return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10809 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-arm-vfp") == 0)
10810 return elfcore_write_arm_vfp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10811 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-tls") == 0)
10812 return elfcore_write_aarch_tls (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10813 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-break") == 0)
10814 return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10815 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch") == 0)
10816 return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
10817 return NULL;
10818 }
10819
10820 static bfd_boolean
10821 elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size, file_ptr offset)
10822 {
10823 char *p;
10824
10825 p = buf;
10826 while (p < buf + size)
10827 {
10828 /* FIXME: bad alignment assumption. */
10829 Elf_External_Note *xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) p;
10830 Elf_Internal_Note in;
10831
10832 if (offsetof (Elf_External_Note, name) > buf - p + size)
10833 return FALSE;
10834
10835 in.type = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->type);
10836
10837 in.namesz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->namesz);
10838 in.namedata = xnp->name;
10839 if (in.namesz > buf - in.namedata + size)
10840 return FALSE;
10841
10842 in.descsz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->descsz);
10843 in.descdata = in.namedata + BFD_ALIGN (in.namesz, 4);
10844 in.descpos = offset + (in.descdata - buf);
10845 if (in.descsz != 0
10846 && (in.descdata >= buf + size
10847 || in.descsz > buf - in.descdata + size))
10848 return FALSE;
10849
10850 switch (bfd_get_format (abfd))
10851 {
10852 default:
10853 return TRUE;
10854
10855 case bfd_core:
10856 {
10857 #define GROKER_ELEMENT(S,F) {S, sizeof (S) - 1, F}
10858 struct
10859 {
10860 const char * string;
10861 size_t len;
10862 bfd_boolean (* func)(bfd *, Elf_Internal_Note *);
10863 }
10864 grokers[] =
10865 {
10866 GROKER_ELEMENT ("", elfcore_grok_note),
10867 GROKER_ELEMENT ("FreeBSD", elfcore_grok_freebsd_note),
10868 GROKER_ELEMENT ("NetBSD-CORE", elfcore_grok_netbsd_note),
10869 GROKER_ELEMENT ( "OpenBSD", elfcore_grok_openbsd_note),
10870 GROKER_ELEMENT ("QNX", elfcore_grok_nto_note),
10871 GROKER_ELEMENT ("SPU/", elfcore_grok_spu_note)
10872 };
10873 #undef GROKER_ELEMENT
10874 int i;
10875
10876 for (i = ARRAY_SIZE (grokers); i--;)
10877 {
10878 if (in.namesz >= grokers[i].len
10879 && strncmp (in.namedata, grokers[i].string,
10880 grokers[i].len) == 0)
10881 {
10882 if (! grokers[i].func (abfd, & in))
10883 return FALSE;
10884 break;
10885 }
10886 }
10887 break;
10888 }
10889
10890 case bfd_object:
10891 if (in.namesz == sizeof "GNU" && strcmp (in.namedata, "GNU") == 0)
10892 {
10893 if (! elfobj_grok_gnu_note (abfd, &in))
10894 return FALSE;
10895 }
10896 else if (in.namesz == sizeof "stapsdt"
10897 && strcmp (in.namedata, "stapsdt") == 0)
10898 {
10899 if (! elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (abfd, &in))
10900 return FALSE;
10901 }
10902 break;
10903 }
10904
10905 p = in.descdata + BFD_ALIGN (in.descsz, 4);
10906 }
10907
10908 return TRUE;
10909 }
10910
10911 static bfd_boolean
10912 elf_read_notes (bfd *abfd, file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type size)
10913 {
10914 char *buf;
10915
10916 if (size <= 0)
10917 return TRUE;
10918
10919 if (bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
10920 return FALSE;
10921
10922 buf = (char *) bfd_malloc (size + 1);
10923 if (buf == NULL)
10924 return FALSE;
10925
10926 /* PR 17512: file: ec08f814
10927 0-termintate the buffer so that string searches will not overflow. */
10928 buf[size] = 0;
10929
10930 if (bfd_bread (buf, size, abfd) != size
10931 || !elf_parse_notes (abfd, buf, size, offset))
10932 {
10933 free (buf);
10934 return FALSE;
10935 }
10936
10937 free (buf);
10938 return TRUE;
10939 }
10940 \f
10941 /* Providing external access to the ELF program header table. */
10942
10943 /* Return an upper bound on the number of bytes required to store a
10944 copy of ABFD's program header table entries. Return -1 if an error
10945 occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
10946
10947 long
10948 bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
10949 {
10950 if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
10951 {
10952 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
10953 return -1;
10954 }
10955
10956 return elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr);
10957 }
10958
10959 /* Copy ABFD's program header table entries to *PHDRS. The entries
10960 will be stored as an array of Elf_Internal_Phdr structures, as
10961 defined in include/elf/internal.h. To find out how large the
10962 buffer needs to be, call bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound.
10963
10964 Return the number of program header table entries read, or -1 if an
10965 error occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
10966
10967 int
10968 bfd_get_elf_phdrs (bfd *abfd, void *phdrs)
10969 {
10970 int num_phdrs;
10971
10972 if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
10973 {
10974 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
10975 return -1;
10976 }
10977
10978 num_phdrs = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
10979 memcpy (phdrs, elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr,
10980 num_phdrs * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
10981
10982 return num_phdrs;
10983 }
10984
10985 enum elf_reloc_type_class
10986 _bfd_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
10987 const asection *rel_sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
10988 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
10989 {
10990 return reloc_class_normal;
10991 }
10992
10993 /* For RELA architectures, return the relocation value for a
10994 relocation against a local symbol. */
10995
10996 bfd_vma
10997 _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
10998 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
10999 asection **psec,
11000 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
11001 {
11002 asection *sec = *psec;
11003 bfd_vma relocation;
11004
11005 relocation = (sec->output_section->vma
11006 + sec->output_offset
11007 + sym->st_value);
11008 if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
11009 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
11010 && sec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
11011 {
11012 rel->r_addend =
11013 _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
11014 elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
11015 sym->st_value + rel->r_addend);
11016 if (sec != *psec)
11017 {
11018 /* If we have changed the section, and our original section is
11019 marked with SEC_EXCLUDE, it means that the original
11020 SEC_MERGE section has been completely subsumed in some
11021 other SEC_MERGE section. In this case, we need to leave
11022 some info around for --emit-relocs. */
11023 if ((sec->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
11024 sec->kept_section = *psec;
11025 sec = *psec;
11026 }
11027 rel->r_addend -= relocation;
11028 rel->r_addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
11029 }
11030 return relocation;
11031 }
11032
11033 bfd_vma
11034 _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
11035 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
11036 asection **psec,
11037 bfd_vma addend)
11038 {
11039 asection *sec = *psec;
11040
11041 if (sec->sec_info_type != SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
11042 return sym->st_value + addend;
11043
11044 return _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
11045 elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
11046 sym->st_value + addend);
11047 }
11048
11049 /* Adjust an address within a section. Given OFFSET within SEC, return
11050 the new offset within the section, based upon changes made to the
11051 section. Returns -1 if the offset is now invalid.
11052 The offset (in abnd out) is in target sized bytes, however big a
11053 byte may be. */
11054
11055 bfd_vma
11056 _bfd_elf_section_offset (bfd *abfd,
11057 struct bfd_link_info *info,
11058 asection *sec,
11059 bfd_vma offset)
11060 {
11061 switch (sec->sec_info_type)
11062 {
11063 case SEC_INFO_TYPE_STABS:
11064 return _bfd_stab_section_offset (sec, elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
11065 offset);
11066 case SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME:
11067 return _bfd_elf_eh_frame_section_offset (abfd, info, sec, offset);
11068
11069 default:
11070 if ((sec->flags & SEC_ELF_REVERSE_COPY) != 0)
11071 {
11072 /* Reverse the offset. */
11073 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
11074 bfd_size_type address_size = bed->s->arch_size / 8;
11075
11076 /* address_size and sec->size are in octets. Convert
11077 to bytes before subtracting the original offset. */
11078 offset = (sec->size - address_size) / bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd) - offset;
11079 }
11080 return offset;
11081 }
11082 }
11083 \f
11084 /* Create a new BFD as if by bfd_openr. Rather than opening a file,
11085 reconstruct an ELF file by reading the segments out of remote memory
11086 based on the ELF file header at EHDR_VMA and the ELF program headers it
11087 points to. If not null, *LOADBASEP is filled in with the difference
11088 between the VMAs from which the segments were read, and the VMAs the
11089 file headers (and hence BFD's idea of each section's VMA) put them at.
11090
11091 The function TARGET_READ_MEMORY is called to copy LEN bytes from the
11092 remote memory at target address VMA into the local buffer at MYADDR; it
11093 should return zero on success or an `errno' code on failure. TEMPL must
11094 be a BFD for an ELF target with the word size and byte order found in
11095 the remote memory. */
11096
11097 bfd *
11098 bfd_elf_bfd_from_remote_memory
11099 (bfd *templ,
11100 bfd_vma ehdr_vma,
11101 bfd_size_type size,
11102 bfd_vma *loadbasep,
11103 int (*target_read_memory) (bfd_vma, bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type))
11104 {
11105 return (*get_elf_backend_data (templ)->elf_backend_bfd_from_remote_memory)
11106 (templ, ehdr_vma, size, loadbasep, target_read_memory);
11107 }
11108 \f
11109 long
11110 _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
11111 long symcount ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11112 asymbol **syms ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11113 long dynsymcount,
11114 asymbol **dynsyms,
11115 asymbol **ret)
11116 {
11117 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
11118 asection *relplt;
11119 asymbol *s;
11120 const char *relplt_name;
11121 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
11122 arelent *p;
11123 long count, i, n;
11124 size_t size;
11125 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
11126 char *names;
11127 asection *plt;
11128
11129 *ret = NULL;
11130
11131 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
11132 return 0;
11133
11134 if (dynsymcount <= 0)
11135 return 0;
11136
11137 if (!bed->plt_sym_val)
11138 return 0;
11139
11140 relplt_name = bed->relplt_name;
11141 if (relplt_name == NULL)
11142 relplt_name = bed->rela_plts_and_copies_p ? ".rela.plt" : ".rel.plt";
11143 relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, relplt_name);
11144 if (relplt == NULL)
11145 return 0;
11146
11147 hdr = &elf_section_data (relplt)->this_hdr;
11148 if (hdr->sh_link != elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
11149 || (hdr->sh_type != SHT_REL && hdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA))
11150 return 0;
11151
11152 plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
11153 if (plt == NULL)
11154 return 0;
11155
11156 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
11157 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
11158 return -1;
11159
11160 count = relplt->size / hdr->sh_entsize;
11161 size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
11162 p = relplt->relocation;
11163 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
11164 {
11165 size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
11166 if (p->addend != 0)
11167 {
11168 #ifdef BFD64
11169 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8 + 8 * (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64);
11170 #else
11171 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
11172 #endif
11173 }
11174 }
11175
11176 s = *ret = (asymbol *) bfd_malloc (size);
11177 if (s == NULL)
11178 return -1;
11179
11180 names = (char *) (s + count);
11181 p = relplt->relocation;
11182 n = 0;
11183 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
11184 {
11185 size_t len;
11186 bfd_vma addr;
11187
11188 addr = bed->plt_sym_val (i, plt, p);
11189 if (addr == (bfd_vma) -1)
11190 continue;
11191
11192 *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
11193 /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
11194 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
11195 if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
11196 s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
11197 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
11198 s->section = plt;
11199 s->value = addr - plt->vma;
11200 s->name = names;
11201 s->udata.p = NULL;
11202 len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
11203 memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
11204 names += len;
11205 if (p->addend != 0)
11206 {
11207 char buf[30], *a;
11208
11209 memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
11210 names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
11211 bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, buf, p->addend);
11212 for (a = buf; *a == '0'; ++a)
11213 ;
11214 len = strlen (a);
11215 memcpy (names, a, len);
11216 names += len;
11217 }
11218 memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
11219 names += sizeof ("@plt");
11220 ++s, ++n;
11221 }
11222
11223 return n;
11224 }
11225
11226 /* It is only used by x86-64 so far.
11227 ??? This repeats *COM* id of zero. sec->id is supposed to be unique,
11228 but current usage would allow all of _bfd_std_section to be zero. t*/
11229 asection _bfd_elf_large_com_section
11230 = BFD_FAKE_SECTION (_bfd_elf_large_com_section, NULL,
11231 "LARGE_COMMON", 0, SEC_IS_COMMON);
11232
11233 void
11234 _bfd_elf_post_process_headers (bfd * abfd,
11235 struct bfd_link_info * link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11236 {
11237 Elf_Internal_Ehdr * i_ehdrp; /* ELF file header, internal form. */
11238
11239 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
11240
11241 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi;
11242
11243 /* To make things simpler for the loader on Linux systems we set the
11244 osabi field to ELFOSABI_GNU if the binary contains symbols of
11245 the STT_GNU_IFUNC type or STB_GNU_UNIQUE binding. */
11246 if (i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] == ELFOSABI_NONE
11247 && elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_symbols)
11248 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = ELFOSABI_GNU;
11249 }
11250
11251
11252 /* Return TRUE for ELF symbol types that represent functions.
11253 This is the default version of this function, which is sufficient for
11254 most targets. It returns true if TYPE is STT_FUNC or STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
11255
11256 bfd_boolean
11257 _bfd_elf_is_function_type (unsigned int type)
11258 {
11259 return (type == STT_FUNC
11260 || type == STT_GNU_IFUNC);
11261 }
11262
11263 /* If the ELF symbol SYM might be a function in SEC, return the
11264 function size and set *CODE_OFF to the function's entry point,
11265 otherwise return zero. */
11266
11267 bfd_size_type
11268 _bfd_elf_maybe_function_sym (const asymbol *sym, asection *sec,
11269 bfd_vma *code_off)
11270 {
11271 bfd_size_type size;
11272
11273 if ((sym->flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_FILE | BSF_OBJECT
11274 | BSF_THREAD_LOCAL | BSF_RELC | BSF_SRELC)) != 0
11275 || sym->section != sec)
11276 return 0;
11277
11278 *code_off = sym->value;
11279 size = 0;
11280 if (!(sym->flags & BSF_SYNTHETIC))
11281 size = ((elf_symbol_type *) sym)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
11282 if (size == 0)
11283 size = 1;
11284 return size;
11285 }